Mark ChangeLog
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / tree-vrp.c
blob96a439a9b8a1b18650e841c4616b0b50e7e37b3f
1 /* Support routines for Value Range Propagation (VRP).
2 Copyright (C) 2005-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Diego Novillo <dnovillo@redhat.com>.
5 This file is part of GCC.
7 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
19 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21 #include "config.h"
22 #include "system.h"
23 #include "coretypes.h"
24 #include "tm.h"
25 #include "ggc.h"
26 #include "flags.h"
27 #include "tree.h"
28 #include "basic-block.h"
29 #include "tree-flow.h"
30 #include "tree-pass.h"
31 #include "tree-dump.h"
32 #include "gimple-pretty-print.h"
33 #include "diagnostic-core.h"
34 #include "intl.h"
35 #include "cfgloop.h"
36 #include "tree-scalar-evolution.h"
37 #include "tree-ssa-propagate.h"
38 #include "tree-chrec.h"
39 #include "gimple-fold.h"
40 #include "expr.h"
41 #include "optabs.h"
44 /* Type of value ranges. See value_range_d for a description of these
45 types. */
46 enum value_range_type { VR_UNDEFINED, VR_RANGE, VR_ANTI_RANGE, VR_VARYING };
48 /* Range of values that can be associated with an SSA_NAME after VRP
49 has executed. */
50 struct value_range_d
52 /* Lattice value represented by this range. */
53 enum value_range_type type;
55 /* Minimum and maximum values represented by this range. These
56 values should be interpreted as follows:
58 - If TYPE is VR_UNDEFINED or VR_VARYING then MIN and MAX must
59 be NULL.
61 - If TYPE == VR_RANGE then MIN holds the minimum value and
62 MAX holds the maximum value of the range [MIN, MAX].
64 - If TYPE == ANTI_RANGE the variable is known to NOT
65 take any values in the range [MIN, MAX]. */
66 tree min;
67 tree max;
69 /* Set of SSA names whose value ranges are equivalent to this one.
70 This set is only valid when TYPE is VR_RANGE or VR_ANTI_RANGE. */
71 bitmap equiv;
74 typedef struct value_range_d value_range_t;
76 #define VR_INITIALIZER { VR_UNDEFINED, NULL_TREE, NULL_TREE, NULL }
78 /* Set of SSA names found live during the RPO traversal of the function
79 for still active basic-blocks. */
80 static sbitmap *live;
82 /* Return true if the SSA name NAME is live on the edge E. */
84 static bool
85 live_on_edge (edge e, tree name)
87 return (live[e->dest->index]
88 && bitmap_bit_p (live[e->dest->index], SSA_NAME_VERSION (name)));
91 /* Local functions. */
92 static int compare_values (tree val1, tree val2);
93 static int compare_values_warnv (tree val1, tree val2, bool *);
94 static void vrp_meet (value_range_t *, value_range_t *);
95 static void vrp_intersect_ranges (value_range_t *, value_range_t *);
96 static tree vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (enum tree_code,
97 tree, tree, bool, bool *,
98 bool *);
100 /* Location information for ASSERT_EXPRs. Each instance of this
101 structure describes an ASSERT_EXPR for an SSA name. Since a single
102 SSA name may have more than one assertion associated with it, these
103 locations are kept in a linked list attached to the corresponding
104 SSA name. */
105 struct assert_locus_d
107 /* Basic block where the assertion would be inserted. */
108 basic_block bb;
110 /* Some assertions need to be inserted on an edge (e.g., assertions
111 generated by COND_EXPRs). In those cases, BB will be NULL. */
112 edge e;
114 /* Pointer to the statement that generated this assertion. */
115 gimple_stmt_iterator si;
117 /* Predicate code for the ASSERT_EXPR. Must be COMPARISON_CLASS_P. */
118 enum tree_code comp_code;
120 /* Value being compared against. */
121 tree val;
123 /* Expression to compare. */
124 tree expr;
126 /* Next node in the linked list. */
127 struct assert_locus_d *next;
130 typedef struct assert_locus_d *assert_locus_t;
132 /* If bit I is present, it means that SSA name N_i has a list of
133 assertions that should be inserted in the IL. */
134 static bitmap need_assert_for;
136 /* Array of locations lists where to insert assertions. ASSERTS_FOR[I]
137 holds a list of ASSERT_LOCUS_T nodes that describe where
138 ASSERT_EXPRs for SSA name N_I should be inserted. */
139 static assert_locus_t *asserts_for;
141 /* Value range array. After propagation, VR_VALUE[I] holds the range
142 of values that SSA name N_I may take. */
143 static unsigned num_vr_values;
144 static value_range_t **vr_value;
145 static bool values_propagated;
147 /* For a PHI node which sets SSA name N_I, VR_COUNTS[I] holds the
148 number of executable edges we saw the last time we visited the
149 node. */
150 static int *vr_phi_edge_counts;
152 typedef struct {
153 gimple stmt;
154 tree vec;
155 } switch_update;
157 static vec<edge> to_remove_edges;
158 static vec<switch_update> to_update_switch_stmts;
161 /* Return the maximum value for TYPE. */
163 static inline tree
164 vrp_val_max (const_tree type)
166 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type))
167 return NULL_TREE;
169 return TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
172 /* Return the minimum value for TYPE. */
174 static inline tree
175 vrp_val_min (const_tree type)
177 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type))
178 return NULL_TREE;
180 return TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
183 /* Return whether VAL is equal to the maximum value of its type. This
184 will be true for a positive overflow infinity. We can't do a
185 simple equality comparison with TYPE_MAX_VALUE because C typedefs
186 and Ada subtypes can produce types whose TYPE_MAX_VALUE is not ==
187 to the integer constant with the same value in the type. */
189 static inline bool
190 vrp_val_is_max (const_tree val)
192 tree type_max = vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (val));
193 return (val == type_max
194 || (type_max != NULL_TREE
195 && operand_equal_p (val, type_max, 0)));
198 /* Return whether VAL is equal to the minimum value of its type. This
199 will be true for a negative overflow infinity. */
201 static inline bool
202 vrp_val_is_min (const_tree val)
204 tree type_min = vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (val));
205 return (val == type_min
206 || (type_min != NULL_TREE
207 && operand_equal_p (val, type_min, 0)));
211 /* Return whether TYPE should use an overflow infinity distinct from
212 TYPE_{MIN,MAX}_VALUE. We use an overflow infinity value to
213 represent a signed overflow during VRP computations. An infinity
214 is distinct from a half-range, which will go from some number to
215 TYPE_{MIN,MAX}_VALUE. */
217 static inline bool
218 needs_overflow_infinity (const_tree type)
220 return INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && !TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (type);
223 /* Return whether TYPE can support our overflow infinity
224 representation: we use the TREE_OVERFLOW flag, which only exists
225 for constants. If TYPE doesn't support this, we don't optimize
226 cases which would require signed overflow--we drop them to
227 VARYING. */
229 static inline bool
230 supports_overflow_infinity (const_tree type)
232 tree min = vrp_val_min (type), max = vrp_val_max (type);
233 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
234 gcc_assert (needs_overflow_infinity (type));
235 #endif
236 return (min != NULL_TREE
237 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (min)
238 && max != NULL_TREE
239 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (max));
242 /* VAL is the maximum or minimum value of a type. Return a
243 corresponding overflow infinity. */
245 static inline tree
246 make_overflow_infinity (tree val)
248 gcc_checking_assert (val != NULL_TREE && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (val));
249 val = copy_node (val);
250 TREE_OVERFLOW (val) = 1;
251 return val;
254 /* Return a negative overflow infinity for TYPE. */
256 static inline tree
257 negative_overflow_infinity (tree type)
259 gcc_checking_assert (supports_overflow_infinity (type));
260 return make_overflow_infinity (vrp_val_min (type));
263 /* Return a positive overflow infinity for TYPE. */
265 static inline tree
266 positive_overflow_infinity (tree type)
268 gcc_checking_assert (supports_overflow_infinity (type));
269 return make_overflow_infinity (vrp_val_max (type));
272 /* Return whether VAL is a negative overflow infinity. */
274 static inline bool
275 is_negative_overflow_infinity (const_tree val)
277 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (val))
278 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (val)
279 && TREE_OVERFLOW (val)
280 && vrp_val_is_min (val));
283 /* Return whether VAL is a positive overflow infinity. */
285 static inline bool
286 is_positive_overflow_infinity (const_tree val)
288 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (val))
289 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (val)
290 && TREE_OVERFLOW (val)
291 && vrp_val_is_max (val));
294 /* Return whether VAL is a positive or negative overflow infinity. */
296 static inline bool
297 is_overflow_infinity (const_tree val)
299 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (val))
300 && CONSTANT_CLASS_P (val)
301 && TREE_OVERFLOW (val)
302 && (vrp_val_is_min (val) || vrp_val_is_max (val)));
305 /* Return whether STMT has a constant rhs that is_overflow_infinity. */
307 static inline bool
308 stmt_overflow_infinity (gimple stmt)
310 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt)
311 && get_gimple_rhs_class (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt)) ==
312 GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS)
313 return is_overflow_infinity (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
314 return false;
317 /* If VAL is now an overflow infinity, return VAL. Otherwise, return
318 the same value with TREE_OVERFLOW clear. This can be used to avoid
319 confusing a regular value with an overflow value. */
321 static inline tree
322 avoid_overflow_infinity (tree val)
324 if (!is_overflow_infinity (val))
325 return val;
327 if (vrp_val_is_max (val))
328 return vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (val));
329 else
331 gcc_checking_assert (vrp_val_is_min (val));
332 return vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (val));
337 /* Return true if ARG is marked with the nonnull attribute in the
338 current function signature. */
340 static bool
341 nonnull_arg_p (const_tree arg)
343 tree t, attrs, fntype;
344 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT arg_num;
346 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (arg) == PARM_DECL && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (arg)));
348 /* The static chain decl is always non null. */
349 if (arg == cfun->static_chain_decl)
350 return true;
352 fntype = TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl);
353 for (attrs = TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (fntype); attrs; attrs = TREE_CHAIN (attrs))
355 attrs = lookup_attribute ("nonnull", attrs);
357 /* If "nonnull" wasn't specified, we know nothing about the argument. */
358 if (attrs == NULL_TREE)
359 return false;
361 /* If "nonnull" applies to all the arguments, then ARG is non-null. */
362 if (TREE_VALUE (attrs) == NULL_TREE)
363 return true;
365 /* Get the position number for ARG in the function signature. */
366 for (arg_num = 1, t = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl);
368 t = DECL_CHAIN (t), arg_num++)
370 if (t == arg)
371 break;
374 gcc_assert (t == arg);
376 /* Now see if ARG_NUM is mentioned in the nonnull list. */
377 for (t = TREE_VALUE (attrs); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
379 if (compare_tree_int (TREE_VALUE (t), arg_num) == 0)
380 return true;
384 return false;
388 /* Set value range VR to VR_UNDEFINED. */
390 static inline void
391 set_value_range_to_undefined (value_range_t *vr)
393 vr->type = VR_UNDEFINED;
394 vr->min = vr->max = NULL_TREE;
395 if (vr->equiv)
396 bitmap_clear (vr->equiv);
400 /* Set value range VR to VR_VARYING. */
402 static inline void
403 set_value_range_to_varying (value_range_t *vr)
405 vr->type = VR_VARYING;
406 vr->min = vr->max = NULL_TREE;
407 if (vr->equiv)
408 bitmap_clear (vr->equiv);
412 /* Set value range VR to {T, MIN, MAX, EQUIV}. */
414 static void
415 set_value_range (value_range_t *vr, enum value_range_type t, tree min,
416 tree max, bitmap equiv)
418 #if defined ENABLE_CHECKING
419 /* Check the validity of the range. */
420 if (t == VR_RANGE || t == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
422 int cmp;
424 gcc_assert (min && max);
426 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (min)) && t == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
427 gcc_assert (!vrp_val_is_min (min) || !vrp_val_is_max (max));
429 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
430 gcc_assert (cmp == 0 || cmp == -1 || cmp == -2);
432 if (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (min)))
433 gcc_assert (!is_overflow_infinity (min)
434 || !is_overflow_infinity (max));
437 if (t == VR_UNDEFINED || t == VR_VARYING)
438 gcc_assert (min == NULL_TREE && max == NULL_TREE);
440 if (t == VR_UNDEFINED || t == VR_VARYING)
441 gcc_assert (equiv == NULL || bitmap_empty_p (equiv));
442 #endif
444 vr->type = t;
445 vr->min = min;
446 vr->max = max;
448 /* Since updating the equivalence set involves deep copying the
449 bitmaps, only do it if absolutely necessary. */
450 if (vr->equiv == NULL
451 && equiv != NULL)
452 vr->equiv = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
454 if (equiv != vr->equiv)
456 if (equiv && !bitmap_empty_p (equiv))
457 bitmap_copy (vr->equiv, equiv);
458 else
459 bitmap_clear (vr->equiv);
464 /* Set value range VR to the canonical form of {T, MIN, MAX, EQUIV}.
465 This means adjusting T, MIN and MAX representing the case of a
466 wrapping range with MAX < MIN covering [MIN, type_max] U [type_min, MAX]
467 as anti-rage ~[MAX+1, MIN-1]. Likewise for wrapping anti-ranges.
468 In corner cases where MAX+1 or MIN-1 wraps this will fall back
469 to varying.
470 This routine exists to ease canonicalization in the case where we
471 extract ranges from var + CST op limit. */
473 static void
474 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (value_range_t *vr, enum value_range_type t,
475 tree min, tree max, bitmap equiv)
477 /* Use the canonical setters for VR_UNDEFINED and VR_VARYING. */
478 if (t == VR_UNDEFINED)
480 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr);
481 return;
483 else if (t == VR_VARYING)
485 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
486 return;
489 /* Nothing to canonicalize for symbolic ranges. */
490 if (TREE_CODE (min) != INTEGER_CST
491 || TREE_CODE (max) != INTEGER_CST)
493 set_value_range (vr, t, min, max, equiv);
494 return;
497 /* Wrong order for min and max, to swap them and the VR type we need
498 to adjust them. */
499 if (tree_int_cst_lt (max, min))
501 tree one, tmp;
503 /* For one bit precision if max < min, then the swapped
504 range covers all values, so for VR_RANGE it is varying and
505 for VR_ANTI_RANGE empty range, so drop to varying as well. */
506 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (min)) == 1)
508 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
509 return;
512 one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), 1);
513 tmp = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, max, one);
514 max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, min, one);
515 min = tmp;
517 /* There's one corner case, if we had [C+1, C] before we now have
518 that again. But this represents an empty value range, so drop
519 to varying in this case. */
520 if (tree_int_cst_lt (max, min))
522 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
523 return;
526 t = t == VR_RANGE ? VR_ANTI_RANGE : VR_RANGE;
529 /* Anti-ranges that can be represented as ranges should be so. */
530 if (t == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
532 bool is_min = vrp_val_is_min (min);
533 bool is_max = vrp_val_is_max (max);
535 if (is_min && is_max)
537 /* We cannot deal with empty ranges, drop to varying.
538 ??? This could be VR_UNDEFINED instead. */
539 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
540 return;
542 else if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (min)) == 1
543 && (is_min || is_max))
545 /* Non-empty boolean ranges can always be represented
546 as a singleton range. */
547 if (is_min)
548 min = max = vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (min));
549 else
550 min = max = vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (min));
551 t = VR_RANGE;
553 else if (is_min
554 /* As a special exception preserve non-null ranges. */
555 && !(TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (min))
556 && integer_zerop (max)))
558 tree one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max), 1);
559 min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, max, one);
560 max = vrp_val_max (TREE_TYPE (max));
561 t = VR_RANGE;
563 else if (is_max)
565 tree one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), 1);
566 max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, min, one);
567 min = vrp_val_min (TREE_TYPE (min));
568 t = VR_RANGE;
572 /* Drop [-INF(OVF), +INF(OVF)] to varying. */
573 if (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (min))
574 && is_overflow_infinity (min)
575 && is_overflow_infinity (max))
577 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
578 return;
581 set_value_range (vr, t, min, max, equiv);
584 /* Copy value range FROM into value range TO. */
586 static inline void
587 copy_value_range (value_range_t *to, value_range_t *from)
589 set_value_range (to, from->type, from->min, from->max, from->equiv);
592 /* Set value range VR to a single value. This function is only called
593 with values we get from statements, and exists to clear the
594 TREE_OVERFLOW flag so that we don't think we have an overflow
595 infinity when we shouldn't. */
597 static inline void
598 set_value_range_to_value (value_range_t *vr, tree val, bitmap equiv)
600 gcc_assert (is_gimple_min_invariant (val));
601 val = avoid_overflow_infinity (val);
602 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, val, val, equiv);
605 /* Set value range VR to a non-negative range of type TYPE.
606 OVERFLOW_INFINITY indicates whether to use an overflow infinity
607 rather than TYPE_MAX_VALUE; this should be true if we determine
608 that the range is nonnegative based on the assumption that signed
609 overflow does not occur. */
611 static inline void
612 set_value_range_to_nonnegative (value_range_t *vr, tree type,
613 bool overflow_infinity)
615 tree zero;
617 if (overflow_infinity && !supports_overflow_infinity (type))
619 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
620 return;
623 zero = build_int_cst (type, 0);
624 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, zero,
625 (overflow_infinity
626 ? positive_overflow_infinity (type)
627 : TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type)),
628 vr->equiv);
631 /* Set value range VR to a non-NULL range of type TYPE. */
633 static inline void
634 set_value_range_to_nonnull (value_range_t *vr, tree type)
636 tree zero = build_int_cst (type, 0);
637 set_value_range (vr, VR_ANTI_RANGE, zero, zero, vr->equiv);
641 /* Set value range VR to a NULL range of type TYPE. */
643 static inline void
644 set_value_range_to_null (value_range_t *vr, tree type)
646 set_value_range_to_value (vr, build_int_cst (type, 0), vr->equiv);
650 /* Set value range VR to a range of a truthvalue of type TYPE. */
652 static inline void
653 set_value_range_to_truthvalue (value_range_t *vr, tree type)
655 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == 1)
656 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
657 else
658 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE,
659 build_int_cst (type, 0), build_int_cst (type, 1),
660 vr->equiv);
664 /* If abs (min) < abs (max), set VR to [-max, max], if
665 abs (min) >= abs (max), set VR to [-min, min]. */
667 static void
668 abs_extent_range (value_range_t *vr, tree min, tree max)
670 int cmp;
672 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (min) == INTEGER_CST);
673 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (max) == INTEGER_CST);
674 gcc_assert (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (min)));
675 gcc_assert (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (min)));
676 min = fold_unary (ABS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), min);
677 max = fold_unary (ABS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (max), max);
678 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (min) || TREE_OVERFLOW (max))
680 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
681 return;
683 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
684 if (cmp == -1)
685 min = fold_unary (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), max);
686 else if (cmp == 0 || cmp == 1)
688 max = min;
689 min = fold_unary (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), min);
691 else
693 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
694 return;
696 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, min, max, NULL);
700 /* Return value range information for VAR.
702 If we have no values ranges recorded (ie, VRP is not running), then
703 return NULL. Otherwise create an empty range if none existed for VAR. */
705 static value_range_t *
706 get_value_range (const_tree var)
708 static const struct value_range_d vr_const_varying
709 = { VR_VARYING, NULL_TREE, NULL_TREE, NULL };
710 value_range_t *vr;
711 tree sym;
712 unsigned ver = SSA_NAME_VERSION (var);
714 /* If we have no recorded ranges, then return NULL. */
715 if (! vr_value)
716 return NULL;
718 /* If we query the range for a new SSA name return an unmodifiable VARYING.
719 We should get here at most from the substitute-and-fold stage which
720 will never try to change values. */
721 if (ver >= num_vr_values)
722 return CONST_CAST (value_range_t *, &vr_const_varying);
724 vr = vr_value[ver];
725 if (vr)
726 return vr;
728 /* After propagation finished do not allocate new value-ranges. */
729 if (values_propagated)
730 return CONST_CAST (value_range_t *, &vr_const_varying);
732 /* Create a default value range. */
733 vr_value[ver] = vr = XCNEW (value_range_t);
735 /* Defer allocating the equivalence set. */
736 vr->equiv = NULL;
738 /* If VAR is a default definition of a parameter, the variable can
739 take any value in VAR's type. */
740 if (SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (var))
742 sym = SSA_NAME_VAR (var);
743 if (TREE_CODE (sym) == PARM_DECL)
745 /* Try to use the "nonnull" attribute to create ~[0, 0]
746 anti-ranges for pointers. Note that this is only valid with
747 default definitions of PARM_DECLs. */
748 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (sym))
749 && nonnull_arg_p (sym))
750 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, TREE_TYPE (sym));
751 else
752 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
754 else if (TREE_CODE (sym) == RESULT_DECL
755 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (sym))
756 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, TREE_TYPE (sym));
759 return vr;
762 /* Return true, if VAL1 and VAL2 are equal values for VRP purposes. */
764 static inline bool
765 vrp_operand_equal_p (const_tree val1, const_tree val2)
767 if (val1 == val2)
768 return true;
769 if (!val1 || !val2 || !operand_equal_p (val1, val2, 0))
770 return false;
771 if (is_overflow_infinity (val1))
772 return is_overflow_infinity (val2);
773 return true;
776 /* Return true, if the bitmaps B1 and B2 are equal. */
778 static inline bool
779 vrp_bitmap_equal_p (const_bitmap b1, const_bitmap b2)
781 return (b1 == b2
782 || ((!b1 || bitmap_empty_p (b1))
783 && (!b2 || bitmap_empty_p (b2)))
784 || (b1 && b2
785 && bitmap_equal_p (b1, b2)));
788 /* Update the value range and equivalence set for variable VAR to
789 NEW_VR. Return true if NEW_VR is different from VAR's previous
790 value.
792 NOTE: This function assumes that NEW_VR is a temporary value range
793 object created for the sole purpose of updating VAR's range. The
794 storage used by the equivalence set from NEW_VR will be freed by
795 this function. Do not call update_value_range when NEW_VR
796 is the range object associated with another SSA name. */
798 static inline bool
799 update_value_range (const_tree var, value_range_t *new_vr)
801 value_range_t *old_vr;
802 bool is_new;
804 /* Update the value range, if necessary. */
805 old_vr = get_value_range (var);
806 is_new = old_vr->type != new_vr->type
807 || !vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr->min, new_vr->min)
808 || !vrp_operand_equal_p (old_vr->max, new_vr->max)
809 || !vrp_bitmap_equal_p (old_vr->equiv, new_vr->equiv);
811 if (is_new)
813 /* Do not allow transitions up the lattice. The following
814 is slightly more awkward than just new_vr->type < old_vr->type
815 because VR_RANGE and VR_ANTI_RANGE need to be considered
816 the same. We may not have is_new when transitioning to
817 UNDEFINED or from VARYING. */
818 if (new_vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED
819 || old_vr->type == VR_VARYING)
820 set_value_range_to_varying (old_vr);
821 else
822 set_value_range (old_vr, new_vr->type, new_vr->min, new_vr->max,
823 new_vr->equiv);
826 BITMAP_FREE (new_vr->equiv);
828 return is_new;
832 /* Add VAR and VAR's equivalence set to EQUIV. This is the central
833 point where equivalence processing can be turned on/off. */
835 static void
836 add_equivalence (bitmap *equiv, const_tree var)
838 unsigned ver = SSA_NAME_VERSION (var);
839 value_range_t *vr = vr_value[ver];
841 if (*equiv == NULL)
842 *equiv = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
843 bitmap_set_bit (*equiv, ver);
844 if (vr && vr->equiv)
845 bitmap_ior_into (*equiv, vr->equiv);
849 /* Return true if VR is ~[0, 0]. */
851 static inline bool
852 range_is_nonnull (value_range_t *vr)
854 return vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
855 && integer_zerop (vr->min)
856 && integer_zerop (vr->max);
860 /* Return true if VR is [0, 0]. */
862 static inline bool
863 range_is_null (value_range_t *vr)
865 return vr->type == VR_RANGE
866 && integer_zerop (vr->min)
867 && integer_zerop (vr->max);
870 /* Return true if max and min of VR are INTEGER_CST. It's not necessary
871 a singleton. */
873 static inline bool
874 range_int_cst_p (value_range_t *vr)
876 return (vr->type == VR_RANGE
877 && TREE_CODE (vr->max) == INTEGER_CST
878 && TREE_CODE (vr->min) == INTEGER_CST);
881 /* Return true if VR is a INTEGER_CST singleton. */
883 static inline bool
884 range_int_cst_singleton_p (value_range_t *vr)
886 return (range_int_cst_p (vr)
887 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (vr->min)
888 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (vr->max)
889 && tree_int_cst_equal (vr->min, vr->max));
892 /* Return true if value range VR involves at least one symbol. */
894 static inline bool
895 symbolic_range_p (value_range_t *vr)
897 return (!is_gimple_min_invariant (vr->min)
898 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (vr->max));
901 /* Return true if value range VR uses an overflow infinity. */
903 static inline bool
904 overflow_infinity_range_p (value_range_t *vr)
906 return (vr->type == VR_RANGE
907 && (is_overflow_infinity (vr->min)
908 || is_overflow_infinity (vr->max)));
911 /* Return false if we can not make a valid comparison based on VR;
912 this will be the case if it uses an overflow infinity and overflow
913 is not undefined (i.e., -fno-strict-overflow is in effect).
914 Otherwise return true, and set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true if VR
915 uses an overflow infinity. */
917 static bool
918 usable_range_p (value_range_t *vr, bool *strict_overflow_p)
920 gcc_assert (vr->type == VR_RANGE);
921 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr->min))
923 *strict_overflow_p = true;
924 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (vr->min)))
925 return false;
927 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr->max))
929 *strict_overflow_p = true;
930 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (vr->max)))
931 return false;
933 return true;
937 /* Return true if the result of assignment STMT is know to be non-negative.
938 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
939 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
940 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
942 static bool
943 gimple_assign_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple stmt, bool *strict_overflow_p)
945 enum tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
946 switch (get_gimple_rhs_class (code))
948 case GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS:
949 return tree_unary_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
950 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
951 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
952 strict_overflow_p);
953 case GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS:
954 return tree_binary_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
955 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
956 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
957 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt),
958 strict_overflow_p);
959 case GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS:
960 return false;
961 case GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS:
962 return tree_single_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
963 strict_overflow_p);
964 case GIMPLE_INVALID_RHS:
965 gcc_unreachable ();
966 default:
967 gcc_unreachable ();
971 /* Return true if return value of call STMT is know to be non-negative.
972 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
973 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
974 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
976 static bool
977 gimple_call_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple stmt, bool *strict_overflow_p)
979 tree arg0 = gimple_call_num_args (stmt) > 0 ?
980 gimple_call_arg (stmt, 0) : NULL_TREE;
981 tree arg1 = gimple_call_num_args (stmt) > 1 ?
982 gimple_call_arg (stmt, 1) : NULL_TREE;
984 return tree_call_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple_expr_type (stmt),
985 gimple_call_fndecl (stmt),
986 arg0,
987 arg1,
988 strict_overflow_p);
991 /* Return true if STMT is know to to compute a non-negative value.
992 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
993 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
994 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
996 static bool
997 gimple_stmt_nonnegative_warnv_p (gimple stmt, bool *strict_overflow_p)
999 switch (gimple_code (stmt))
1001 case GIMPLE_ASSIGN:
1002 return gimple_assign_nonnegative_warnv_p (stmt, strict_overflow_p);
1003 case GIMPLE_CALL:
1004 return gimple_call_nonnegative_warnv_p (stmt, strict_overflow_p);
1005 default:
1006 gcc_unreachable ();
1010 /* Return true if the result of assignment STMT is know to be non-zero.
1011 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
1012 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
1013 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
1015 static bool
1016 gimple_assign_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple stmt, bool *strict_overflow_p)
1018 enum tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
1019 switch (get_gimple_rhs_class (code))
1021 case GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS:
1022 return tree_unary_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
1023 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
1024 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
1025 strict_overflow_p);
1026 case GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS:
1027 return tree_binary_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
1028 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
1029 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
1030 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt),
1031 strict_overflow_p);
1032 case GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS:
1033 return false;
1034 case GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS:
1035 return tree_single_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
1036 strict_overflow_p);
1037 case GIMPLE_INVALID_RHS:
1038 gcc_unreachable ();
1039 default:
1040 gcc_unreachable ();
1044 /* Return true if STMT is know to to compute a non-zero value.
1045 If the return value is based on the assumption that signed overflow is
1046 undefined, set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to true; otherwise, don't change
1047 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P.*/
1049 static bool
1050 gimple_stmt_nonzero_warnv_p (gimple stmt, bool *strict_overflow_p)
1052 switch (gimple_code (stmt))
1054 case GIMPLE_ASSIGN:
1055 return gimple_assign_nonzero_warnv_p (stmt, strict_overflow_p);
1056 case GIMPLE_CALL:
1057 return gimple_alloca_call_p (stmt);
1058 default:
1059 gcc_unreachable ();
1063 /* Like tree_expr_nonzero_warnv_p, but this function uses value ranges
1064 obtained so far. */
1066 static bool
1067 vrp_stmt_computes_nonzero (gimple stmt, bool *strict_overflow_p)
1069 if (gimple_stmt_nonzero_warnv_p (stmt, strict_overflow_p))
1070 return true;
1072 /* If we have an expression of the form &X->a, then the expression
1073 is nonnull if X is nonnull. */
1074 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt)
1075 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt) == ADDR_EXPR)
1077 tree expr = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
1078 tree base = get_base_address (TREE_OPERAND (expr, 0));
1080 if (base != NULL_TREE
1081 && TREE_CODE (base) == MEM_REF
1082 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (base, 0)) == SSA_NAME)
1084 value_range_t *vr = get_value_range (TREE_OPERAND (base, 0));
1085 if (range_is_nonnull (vr))
1086 return true;
1090 return false;
1093 /* Returns true if EXPR is a valid value (as expected by compare_values) --
1094 a gimple invariant, or SSA_NAME +- CST. */
1096 static bool
1097 valid_value_p (tree expr)
1099 if (TREE_CODE (expr) == SSA_NAME)
1100 return true;
1102 if (TREE_CODE (expr) == PLUS_EXPR
1103 || TREE_CODE (expr) == MINUS_EXPR)
1104 return (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (expr, 0)) == SSA_NAME
1105 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (expr, 1)) == INTEGER_CST);
1107 return is_gimple_min_invariant (expr);
1110 /* Return
1111 1 if VAL < VAL2
1112 0 if !(VAL < VAL2)
1113 -2 if those are incomparable. */
1114 static inline int
1115 operand_less_p (tree val, tree val2)
1117 /* LT is folded faster than GE and others. Inline the common case. */
1118 if (TREE_CODE (val) == INTEGER_CST && TREE_CODE (val2) == INTEGER_CST)
1120 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val)))
1121 return INT_CST_LT_UNSIGNED (val, val2);
1122 else
1124 if (INT_CST_LT (val, val2))
1125 return 1;
1128 else
1130 tree tcmp;
1132 fold_defer_overflow_warnings ();
1134 tcmp = fold_binary_to_constant (LT_EXPR, boolean_type_node, val, val2);
1136 fold_undefer_and_ignore_overflow_warnings ();
1138 if (!tcmp
1139 || TREE_CODE (tcmp) != INTEGER_CST)
1140 return -2;
1142 if (!integer_zerop (tcmp))
1143 return 1;
1146 /* val >= val2, not considering overflow infinity. */
1147 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (val))
1148 return is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2) ? 0 : 1;
1149 else if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2))
1150 return is_positive_overflow_infinity (val) ? 0 : 1;
1152 return 0;
1155 /* Compare two values VAL1 and VAL2. Return
1157 -2 if VAL1 and VAL2 cannot be compared at compile-time,
1158 -1 if VAL1 < VAL2,
1159 0 if VAL1 == VAL2,
1160 +1 if VAL1 > VAL2, and
1161 +2 if VAL1 != VAL2
1163 This is similar to tree_int_cst_compare but supports pointer values
1164 and values that cannot be compared at compile time.
1166 If STRICT_OVERFLOW_P is not NULL, then set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to
1167 true if the return value is only valid if we assume that signed
1168 overflow is undefined. */
1170 static int
1171 compare_values_warnv (tree val1, tree val2, bool *strict_overflow_p)
1173 if (val1 == val2)
1174 return 0;
1176 /* Below we rely on the fact that VAL1 and VAL2 are both pointers or
1177 both integers. */
1178 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val1))
1179 == POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val2)));
1180 /* Convert the two values into the same type. This is needed because
1181 sizetype causes sign extension even for unsigned types. */
1182 val2 = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (val1), val2);
1183 STRIP_USELESS_TYPE_CONVERSION (val2);
1185 if ((TREE_CODE (val1) == SSA_NAME
1186 || TREE_CODE (val1) == PLUS_EXPR
1187 || TREE_CODE (val1) == MINUS_EXPR)
1188 && (TREE_CODE (val2) == SSA_NAME
1189 || TREE_CODE (val2) == PLUS_EXPR
1190 || TREE_CODE (val2) == MINUS_EXPR))
1192 tree n1, c1, n2, c2;
1193 enum tree_code code1, code2;
1195 /* If VAL1 and VAL2 are of the form 'NAME [+-] CST' or 'NAME',
1196 return -1 or +1 accordingly. If VAL1 and VAL2 don't use the
1197 same name, return -2. */
1198 if (TREE_CODE (val1) == SSA_NAME)
1200 code1 = SSA_NAME;
1201 n1 = val1;
1202 c1 = NULL_TREE;
1204 else
1206 code1 = TREE_CODE (val1);
1207 n1 = TREE_OPERAND (val1, 0);
1208 c1 = TREE_OPERAND (val1, 1);
1209 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (c1) == -1)
1211 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (c1))
1212 return -2;
1213 c1 = fold_unary_to_constant (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (c1), c1);
1214 if (!c1)
1215 return -2;
1216 code1 = code1 == MINUS_EXPR ? PLUS_EXPR : MINUS_EXPR;
1220 if (TREE_CODE (val2) == SSA_NAME)
1222 code2 = SSA_NAME;
1223 n2 = val2;
1224 c2 = NULL_TREE;
1226 else
1228 code2 = TREE_CODE (val2);
1229 n2 = TREE_OPERAND (val2, 0);
1230 c2 = TREE_OPERAND (val2, 1);
1231 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (c2) == -1)
1233 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (c2))
1234 return -2;
1235 c2 = fold_unary_to_constant (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (c2), c2);
1236 if (!c2)
1237 return -2;
1238 code2 = code2 == MINUS_EXPR ? PLUS_EXPR : MINUS_EXPR;
1242 /* Both values must use the same name. */
1243 if (n1 != n2)
1244 return -2;
1246 if (code1 == SSA_NAME
1247 && code2 == SSA_NAME)
1248 /* NAME == NAME */
1249 return 0;
1251 /* If overflow is defined we cannot simplify more. */
1252 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (val1)))
1253 return -2;
1255 if (strict_overflow_p != NULL
1256 && (code1 == SSA_NAME || !TREE_NO_WARNING (val1))
1257 && (code2 == SSA_NAME || !TREE_NO_WARNING (val2)))
1258 *strict_overflow_p = true;
1260 if (code1 == SSA_NAME)
1262 if (code2 == PLUS_EXPR)
1263 /* NAME < NAME + CST */
1264 return -1;
1265 else if (code2 == MINUS_EXPR)
1266 /* NAME > NAME - CST */
1267 return 1;
1269 else if (code1 == PLUS_EXPR)
1271 if (code2 == SSA_NAME)
1272 /* NAME + CST > NAME */
1273 return 1;
1274 else if (code2 == PLUS_EXPR)
1275 /* NAME + CST1 > NAME + CST2, if CST1 > CST2 */
1276 return compare_values_warnv (c1, c2, strict_overflow_p);
1277 else if (code2 == MINUS_EXPR)
1278 /* NAME + CST1 > NAME - CST2 */
1279 return 1;
1281 else if (code1 == MINUS_EXPR)
1283 if (code2 == SSA_NAME)
1284 /* NAME - CST < NAME */
1285 return -1;
1286 else if (code2 == PLUS_EXPR)
1287 /* NAME - CST1 < NAME + CST2 */
1288 return -1;
1289 else if (code2 == MINUS_EXPR)
1290 /* NAME - CST1 > NAME - CST2, if CST1 < CST2. Notice that
1291 C1 and C2 are swapped in the call to compare_values. */
1292 return compare_values_warnv (c2, c1, strict_overflow_p);
1295 gcc_unreachable ();
1298 /* We cannot compare non-constants. */
1299 if (!is_gimple_min_invariant (val1) || !is_gimple_min_invariant (val2))
1300 return -2;
1302 if (!POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val1)))
1304 /* We cannot compare overflowed values, except for overflow
1305 infinities. */
1306 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (val1) || TREE_OVERFLOW (val2))
1308 if (strict_overflow_p != NULL)
1309 *strict_overflow_p = true;
1310 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (val1))
1311 return is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2) ? 0 : -1;
1312 else if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2))
1313 return 1;
1314 else if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (val1))
1315 return is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2) ? 0 : 1;
1316 else if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2))
1317 return -1;
1318 return -2;
1321 return tree_int_cst_compare (val1, val2);
1323 else
1325 tree t;
1327 /* First see if VAL1 and VAL2 are not the same. */
1328 if (val1 == val2 || operand_equal_p (val1, val2, 0))
1329 return 0;
1331 /* If VAL1 is a lower address than VAL2, return -1. */
1332 if (operand_less_p (val1, val2) == 1)
1333 return -1;
1335 /* If VAL1 is a higher address than VAL2, return +1. */
1336 if (operand_less_p (val2, val1) == 1)
1337 return 1;
1339 /* If VAL1 is different than VAL2, return +2.
1340 For integer constants we either have already returned -1 or 1
1341 or they are equivalent. We still might succeed in proving
1342 something about non-trivial operands. */
1343 if (TREE_CODE (val1) != INTEGER_CST
1344 || TREE_CODE (val2) != INTEGER_CST)
1346 t = fold_binary_to_constant (NE_EXPR, boolean_type_node, val1, val2);
1347 if (t && integer_onep (t))
1348 return 2;
1351 return -2;
1355 /* Compare values like compare_values_warnv, but treat comparisons of
1356 nonconstants which rely on undefined overflow as incomparable. */
1358 static int
1359 compare_values (tree val1, tree val2)
1361 bool sop;
1362 int ret;
1364 sop = false;
1365 ret = compare_values_warnv (val1, val2, &sop);
1366 if (sop
1367 && (!is_gimple_min_invariant (val1) || !is_gimple_min_invariant (val2)))
1368 ret = -2;
1369 return ret;
1373 /* Return 1 if VAL is inside value range MIN <= VAL <= MAX,
1374 0 if VAL is not inside [MIN, MAX],
1375 -2 if we cannot tell either way.
1377 Benchmark compile/20001226-1.c compilation time after changing this
1378 function. */
1380 static inline int
1381 value_inside_range (tree val, tree min, tree max)
1383 int cmp1, cmp2;
1385 cmp1 = operand_less_p (val, min);
1386 if (cmp1 == -2)
1387 return -2;
1388 if (cmp1 == 1)
1389 return 0;
1391 cmp2 = operand_less_p (max, val);
1392 if (cmp2 == -2)
1393 return -2;
1395 return !cmp2;
1399 /* Return true if value ranges VR0 and VR1 have a non-empty
1400 intersection.
1402 Benchmark compile/20001226-1.c compilation time after changing this
1403 function.
1406 static inline bool
1407 value_ranges_intersect_p (value_range_t *vr0, value_range_t *vr1)
1409 /* The value ranges do not intersect if the maximum of the first range is
1410 less than the minimum of the second range or vice versa.
1411 When those relations are unknown, we can't do any better. */
1412 if (operand_less_p (vr0->max, vr1->min) != 0)
1413 return false;
1414 if (operand_less_p (vr1->max, vr0->min) != 0)
1415 return false;
1416 return true;
1420 /* Return 1 if [MIN, MAX] includes the value zero, 0 if it does not
1421 include the value zero, -2 if we cannot tell. */
1423 static inline int
1424 range_includes_zero_p (tree min, tree max)
1426 tree zero = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), 0);
1427 return value_inside_range (zero, min, max);
1430 /* Return true if *VR is know to only contain nonnegative values. */
1432 static inline bool
1433 value_range_nonnegative_p (value_range_t *vr)
1435 /* Testing for VR_ANTI_RANGE is not useful here as any anti-range
1436 which would return a useful value should be encoded as a
1437 VR_RANGE. */
1438 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
1440 int result = compare_values (vr->min, integer_zero_node);
1441 return (result == 0 || result == 1);
1444 return false;
1447 /* Return true if T, an SSA_NAME, is known to be nonnegative. Return
1448 false otherwise or if no value range information is available. */
1450 bool
1451 ssa_name_nonnegative_p (const_tree t)
1453 value_range_t *vr = get_value_range (t);
1455 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (t)
1456 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
1457 return true;
1459 if (!vr)
1460 return false;
1462 return value_range_nonnegative_p (vr);
1465 /* If *VR has a value rante that is a single constant value return that,
1466 otherwise return NULL_TREE. */
1468 static tree
1469 value_range_constant_singleton (value_range_t *vr)
1471 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE
1472 && operand_equal_p (vr->min, vr->max, 0)
1473 && is_gimple_min_invariant (vr->min))
1474 return vr->min;
1476 return NULL_TREE;
1479 /* If OP has a value range with a single constant value return that,
1480 otherwise return NULL_TREE. This returns OP itself if OP is a
1481 constant. */
1483 static tree
1484 op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (tree op)
1486 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op))
1487 return op;
1489 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
1490 return NULL_TREE;
1492 return value_range_constant_singleton (get_value_range (op));
1495 /* Return true if op is in a boolean [0, 1] value-range. */
1497 static bool
1498 op_with_boolean_value_range_p (tree op)
1500 value_range_t *vr;
1502 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (op)) == 1)
1503 return true;
1505 if (integer_zerop (op)
1506 || integer_onep (op))
1507 return true;
1509 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
1510 return false;
1512 vr = get_value_range (op);
1513 return (vr->type == VR_RANGE
1514 && integer_zerop (vr->min)
1515 && integer_onep (vr->max));
1518 /* Extract value range information from an ASSERT_EXPR EXPR and store
1519 it in *VR_P. */
1521 static void
1522 extract_range_from_assert (value_range_t *vr_p, tree expr)
1524 tree var, cond, limit, min, max, type;
1525 value_range_t *limit_vr;
1526 enum tree_code cond_code;
1528 var = ASSERT_EXPR_VAR (expr);
1529 cond = ASSERT_EXPR_COND (expr);
1531 gcc_assert (COMPARISON_CLASS_P (cond));
1533 /* Find VAR in the ASSERT_EXPR conditional. */
1534 if (var == TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0)
1535 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0)) == PLUS_EXPR
1536 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0)) == NOP_EXPR)
1538 /* If the predicate is of the form VAR COMP LIMIT, then we just
1539 take LIMIT from the RHS and use the same comparison code. */
1540 cond_code = TREE_CODE (cond);
1541 limit = TREE_OPERAND (cond, 1);
1542 cond = TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0);
1544 else
1546 /* If the predicate is of the form LIMIT COMP VAR, then we need
1547 to flip around the comparison code to create the proper range
1548 for VAR. */
1549 cond_code = swap_tree_comparison (TREE_CODE (cond));
1550 limit = TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0);
1551 cond = TREE_OPERAND (cond, 1);
1554 limit = avoid_overflow_infinity (limit);
1556 type = TREE_TYPE (var);
1557 gcc_assert (limit != var);
1559 /* For pointer arithmetic, we only keep track of pointer equality
1560 and inequality. */
1561 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type) && cond_code != NE_EXPR && cond_code != EQ_EXPR)
1563 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_p);
1564 return;
1567 /* If LIMIT is another SSA name and LIMIT has a range of its own,
1568 try to use LIMIT's range to avoid creating symbolic ranges
1569 unnecessarily. */
1570 limit_vr = (TREE_CODE (limit) == SSA_NAME) ? get_value_range (limit) : NULL;
1572 /* LIMIT's range is only interesting if it has any useful information. */
1573 if (limit_vr
1574 && (limit_vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED
1575 || limit_vr->type == VR_VARYING
1576 || symbolic_range_p (limit_vr)))
1577 limit_vr = NULL;
1579 /* Initially, the new range has the same set of equivalences of
1580 VAR's range. This will be revised before returning the final
1581 value. Since assertions may be chained via mutually exclusive
1582 predicates, we will need to trim the set of equivalences before
1583 we are done. */
1584 gcc_assert (vr_p->equiv == NULL);
1585 add_equivalence (&vr_p->equiv, var);
1587 /* Extract a new range based on the asserted comparison for VAR and
1588 LIMIT's value range. Notice that if LIMIT has an anti-range, we
1589 will only use it for equality comparisons (EQ_EXPR). For any
1590 other kind of assertion, we cannot derive a range from LIMIT's
1591 anti-range that can be used to describe the new range. For
1592 instance, ASSERT_EXPR <x_2, x_2 <= b_4>. If b_4 is ~[2, 10],
1593 then b_4 takes on the ranges [-INF, 1] and [11, +INF]. There is
1594 no single range for x_2 that could describe LE_EXPR, so we might
1595 as well build the range [b_4, +INF] for it.
1596 One special case we handle is extracting a range from a
1597 range test encoded as (unsigned)var + CST <= limit. */
1598 if (TREE_CODE (cond) == NOP_EXPR
1599 || TREE_CODE (cond) == PLUS_EXPR)
1601 if (TREE_CODE (cond) == PLUS_EXPR)
1603 min = fold_build1 (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (cond, 1)),
1604 TREE_OPERAND (cond, 1));
1605 max = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, limit, min);
1606 cond = TREE_OPERAND (cond, 0);
1608 else
1610 min = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (var), 0);
1611 max = limit;
1614 /* Make sure to not set TREE_OVERFLOW on the final type
1615 conversion. We are willingly interpreting large positive
1616 unsigned values as negative singed values here. */
1617 min = force_fit_type_double (TREE_TYPE (var), tree_to_double_int (min),
1618 0, false);
1619 max = force_fit_type_double (TREE_TYPE (var), tree_to_double_int (max),
1620 0, false);
1622 /* We can transform a max, min range to an anti-range or
1623 vice-versa. Use set_and_canonicalize_value_range which does
1624 this for us. */
1625 if (cond_code == LE_EXPR)
1626 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr_p, VR_RANGE,
1627 min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1628 else if (cond_code == GT_EXPR)
1629 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr_p, VR_ANTI_RANGE,
1630 min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1631 else
1632 gcc_unreachable ();
1634 else if (cond_code == EQ_EXPR)
1636 enum value_range_type range_type;
1638 if (limit_vr)
1640 range_type = limit_vr->type;
1641 min = limit_vr->min;
1642 max = limit_vr->max;
1644 else
1646 range_type = VR_RANGE;
1647 min = limit;
1648 max = limit;
1651 set_value_range (vr_p, range_type, min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1653 /* When asserting the equality VAR == LIMIT and LIMIT is another
1654 SSA name, the new range will also inherit the equivalence set
1655 from LIMIT. */
1656 if (TREE_CODE (limit) == SSA_NAME)
1657 add_equivalence (&vr_p->equiv, limit);
1659 else if (cond_code == NE_EXPR)
1661 /* As described above, when LIMIT's range is an anti-range and
1662 this assertion is an inequality (NE_EXPR), then we cannot
1663 derive anything from the anti-range. For instance, if
1664 LIMIT's range was ~[0, 0], the assertion 'VAR != LIMIT' does
1665 not imply that VAR's range is [0, 0]. So, in the case of
1666 anti-ranges, we just assert the inequality using LIMIT and
1667 not its anti-range.
1669 If LIMIT_VR is a range, we can only use it to build a new
1670 anti-range if LIMIT_VR is a single-valued range. For
1671 instance, if LIMIT_VR is [0, 1], the predicate
1672 VAR != [0, 1] does not mean that VAR's range is ~[0, 1].
1673 Rather, it means that for value 0 VAR should be ~[0, 0]
1674 and for value 1, VAR should be ~[1, 1]. We cannot
1675 represent these ranges.
1677 The only situation in which we can build a valid
1678 anti-range is when LIMIT_VR is a single-valued range
1679 (i.e., LIMIT_VR->MIN == LIMIT_VR->MAX). In that case,
1680 build the anti-range ~[LIMIT_VR->MIN, LIMIT_VR->MAX]. */
1681 if (limit_vr
1682 && limit_vr->type == VR_RANGE
1683 && compare_values (limit_vr->min, limit_vr->max) == 0)
1685 min = limit_vr->min;
1686 max = limit_vr->max;
1688 else
1690 /* In any other case, we cannot use LIMIT's range to build a
1691 valid anti-range. */
1692 min = max = limit;
1695 /* If MIN and MAX cover the whole range for their type, then
1696 just use the original LIMIT. */
1697 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
1698 && vrp_val_is_min (min)
1699 && vrp_val_is_max (max))
1700 min = max = limit;
1702 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr_p, VR_ANTI_RANGE,
1703 min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1705 else if (cond_code == LE_EXPR || cond_code == LT_EXPR)
1707 min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
1709 if (limit_vr == NULL || limit_vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
1710 max = limit;
1711 else
1713 /* If LIMIT_VR is of the form [N1, N2], we need to build the
1714 range [MIN, N2] for LE_EXPR and [MIN, N2 - 1] for
1715 LT_EXPR. */
1716 max = limit_vr->max;
1719 /* If the maximum value forces us to be out of bounds, simply punt.
1720 It would be pointless to try and do anything more since this
1721 all should be optimized away above us. */
1722 if ((cond_code == LT_EXPR
1723 && compare_values (max, min) == 0)
1724 || (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (max) && TREE_OVERFLOW (max)))
1725 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_p);
1726 else
1728 /* For LT_EXPR, we create the range [MIN, MAX - 1]. */
1729 if (cond_code == LT_EXPR)
1731 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (max)) == 1
1732 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (max)))
1733 max = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (max), max,
1734 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max), -1));
1735 else
1736 max = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (max), max,
1737 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max), 1));
1738 if (EXPR_P (max))
1739 TREE_NO_WARNING (max) = 1;
1742 set_value_range (vr_p, VR_RANGE, min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1745 else if (cond_code == GE_EXPR || cond_code == GT_EXPR)
1747 max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
1749 if (limit_vr == NULL || limit_vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
1750 min = limit;
1751 else
1753 /* If LIMIT_VR is of the form [N1, N2], we need to build the
1754 range [N1, MAX] for GE_EXPR and [N1 + 1, MAX] for
1755 GT_EXPR. */
1756 min = limit_vr->min;
1759 /* If the minimum value forces us to be out of bounds, simply punt.
1760 It would be pointless to try and do anything more since this
1761 all should be optimized away above us. */
1762 if ((cond_code == GT_EXPR
1763 && compare_values (min, max) == 0)
1764 || (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (min) && TREE_OVERFLOW (min)))
1765 set_value_range_to_varying (vr_p);
1766 else
1768 /* For GT_EXPR, we create the range [MIN + 1, MAX]. */
1769 if (cond_code == GT_EXPR)
1771 if (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (min)) == 1
1772 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (min)))
1773 min = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), min,
1774 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), -1));
1775 else
1776 min = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (min), min,
1777 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (min), 1));
1778 if (EXPR_P (min))
1779 TREE_NO_WARNING (min) = 1;
1782 set_value_range (vr_p, VR_RANGE, min, max, vr_p->equiv);
1785 else
1786 gcc_unreachable ();
1788 /* Finally intersect the new range with what we already know about var. */
1789 vrp_intersect_ranges (vr_p, get_value_range (var));
1793 /* Extract range information from SSA name VAR and store it in VR. If
1794 VAR has an interesting range, use it. Otherwise, create the
1795 range [VAR, VAR] and return it. This is useful in situations where
1796 we may have conditionals testing values of VARYING names. For
1797 instance,
1799 x_3 = y_5;
1800 if (x_3 > y_5)
1803 Even if y_5 is deemed VARYING, we can determine that x_3 > y_5 is
1804 always false. */
1806 static void
1807 extract_range_from_ssa_name (value_range_t *vr, tree var)
1809 value_range_t *var_vr = get_value_range (var);
1811 if (var_vr->type != VR_UNDEFINED && var_vr->type != VR_VARYING)
1812 copy_value_range (vr, var_vr);
1813 else
1814 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, var, var, NULL);
1816 add_equivalence (&vr->equiv, var);
1820 /* Wrapper around int_const_binop. If the operation overflows and we
1821 are not using wrapping arithmetic, then adjust the result to be
1822 -INF or +INF depending on CODE, VAL1 and VAL2. This can return
1823 NULL_TREE if we need to use an overflow infinity representation but
1824 the type does not support it. */
1826 static tree
1827 vrp_int_const_binop (enum tree_code code, tree val1, tree val2)
1829 tree res;
1831 res = int_const_binop (code, val1, val2);
1833 /* If we are using unsigned arithmetic, operate symbolically
1834 on -INF and +INF as int_const_binop only handles signed overflow. */
1835 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val1)))
1837 int checkz = compare_values (res, val1);
1838 bool overflow = false;
1840 /* Ensure that res = val1 [+*] val2 >= val1
1841 or that res = val1 - val2 <= val1. */
1842 if ((code == PLUS_EXPR
1843 && !(checkz == 1 || checkz == 0))
1844 || (code == MINUS_EXPR
1845 && !(checkz == 0 || checkz == -1)))
1847 overflow = true;
1849 /* Checking for multiplication overflow is done by dividing the
1850 output of the multiplication by the first input of the
1851 multiplication. If the result of that division operation is
1852 not equal to the second input of the multiplication, then the
1853 multiplication overflowed. */
1854 else if (code == MULT_EXPR && !integer_zerop (val1))
1856 tree tmp = int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
1857 res,
1858 val1);
1859 int check = compare_values (tmp, val2);
1861 if (check != 0)
1862 overflow = true;
1865 if (overflow)
1867 res = copy_node (res);
1868 TREE_OVERFLOW (res) = 1;
1872 else if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (TREE_TYPE (val1)))
1873 /* If the singed operation wraps then int_const_binop has done
1874 everything we want. */
1876 else if ((TREE_OVERFLOW (res)
1877 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (val1)
1878 && !TREE_OVERFLOW (val2))
1879 || is_overflow_infinity (val1)
1880 || is_overflow_infinity (val2))
1882 /* If the operation overflowed but neither VAL1 nor VAL2 are
1883 overflown, return -INF or +INF depending on the operation
1884 and the combination of signs of the operands. */
1885 int sgn1 = tree_int_cst_sgn (val1);
1886 int sgn2 = tree_int_cst_sgn (val2);
1888 if (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1889 && !supports_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res)))
1890 return NULL_TREE;
1892 /* We have to punt on adding infinities of different signs,
1893 since we can't tell what the sign of the result should be.
1894 Likewise for subtracting infinities of the same sign. */
1895 if (((code == PLUS_EXPR && sgn1 != sgn2)
1896 || (code == MINUS_EXPR && sgn1 == sgn2))
1897 && is_overflow_infinity (val1)
1898 && is_overflow_infinity (val2))
1899 return NULL_TREE;
1901 /* Don't try to handle division or shifting of infinities. */
1902 if ((code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
1903 || code == FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
1904 || code == CEIL_DIV_EXPR
1905 || code == EXACT_DIV_EXPR
1906 || code == ROUND_DIV_EXPR
1907 || code == RSHIFT_EXPR)
1908 && (is_overflow_infinity (val1)
1909 || is_overflow_infinity (val2)))
1910 return NULL_TREE;
1912 /* Notice that we only need to handle the restricted set of
1913 operations handled by extract_range_from_binary_expr.
1914 Among them, only multiplication, addition and subtraction
1915 can yield overflow without overflown operands because we
1916 are working with integral types only... except in the
1917 case VAL1 = -INF and VAL2 = -1 which overflows to +INF
1918 for division too. */
1920 /* For multiplication, the sign of the overflow is given
1921 by the comparison of the signs of the operands. */
1922 if ((code == MULT_EXPR && sgn1 == sgn2)
1923 /* For addition, the operands must be of the same sign
1924 to yield an overflow. Its sign is therefore that
1925 of one of the operands, for example the first. For
1926 infinite operands X + -INF is negative, not positive. */
1927 || (code == PLUS_EXPR
1928 && (sgn1 >= 0
1929 ? !is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2)
1930 : is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2)))
1931 /* For subtraction, non-infinite operands must be of
1932 different signs to yield an overflow. Its sign is
1933 therefore that of the first operand or the opposite of
1934 that of the second operand. A first operand of 0 counts
1935 as positive here, for the corner case 0 - (-INF), which
1936 overflows, but must yield +INF. For infinite operands 0
1937 - INF is negative, not positive. */
1938 || (code == MINUS_EXPR
1939 && (sgn1 >= 0
1940 ? !is_positive_overflow_infinity (val2)
1941 : is_negative_overflow_infinity (val2)))
1942 /* We only get in here with positive shift count, so the
1943 overflow direction is the same as the sign of val1.
1944 Actually rshift does not overflow at all, but we only
1945 handle the case of shifting overflowed -INF and +INF. */
1946 || (code == RSHIFT_EXPR
1947 && sgn1 >= 0)
1948 /* For division, the only case is -INF / -1 = +INF. */
1949 || code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
1950 || code == FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
1951 || code == CEIL_DIV_EXPR
1952 || code == EXACT_DIV_EXPR
1953 || code == ROUND_DIV_EXPR)
1954 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1955 ? positive_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1956 : TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (res)));
1957 else
1958 return (needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1959 ? negative_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (res))
1960 : TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (res)));
1963 return res;
1967 /* For range VR compute two double_int bitmasks. In *MAY_BE_NONZERO
1968 bitmask if some bit is unset, it means for all numbers in the range
1969 the bit is 0, otherwise it might be 0 or 1. In *MUST_BE_NONZERO
1970 bitmask if some bit is set, it means for all numbers in the range
1971 the bit is 1, otherwise it might be 0 or 1. */
1973 static bool
1974 zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (value_range_t *vr,
1975 double_int *may_be_nonzero,
1976 double_int *must_be_nonzero)
1978 *may_be_nonzero = double_int_minus_one;
1979 *must_be_nonzero = double_int_zero;
1980 if (!range_int_cst_p (vr)
1981 || TREE_OVERFLOW (vr->min)
1982 || TREE_OVERFLOW (vr->max))
1983 return false;
1985 if (range_int_cst_singleton_p (vr))
1987 *may_be_nonzero = tree_to_double_int (vr->min);
1988 *must_be_nonzero = *may_be_nonzero;
1990 else if (tree_int_cst_sgn (vr->min) >= 0
1991 || tree_int_cst_sgn (vr->max) < 0)
1993 double_int dmin = tree_to_double_int (vr->min);
1994 double_int dmax = tree_to_double_int (vr->max);
1995 double_int xor_mask = dmin ^ dmax;
1996 *may_be_nonzero = dmin | dmax;
1997 *must_be_nonzero = dmin & dmax;
1998 if (xor_mask.high != 0)
2000 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
2001 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
2002 << floor_log2 (xor_mask.high)) - 1;
2003 may_be_nonzero->low = ALL_ONES;
2004 may_be_nonzero->high |= mask;
2005 must_be_nonzero->low = 0;
2006 must_be_nonzero->high &= ~mask;
2008 else if (xor_mask.low != 0)
2010 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
2011 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
2012 << floor_log2 (xor_mask.low)) - 1;
2013 may_be_nonzero->low |= mask;
2014 must_be_nonzero->low &= ~mask;
2018 return true;
2021 /* Create two value-ranges in *VR0 and *VR1 from the anti-range *AR
2022 so that *VR0 U *VR1 == *AR. Returns true if that is possible,
2023 false otherwise. If *AR can be represented with a single range
2024 *VR1 will be VR_UNDEFINED. */
2026 static bool
2027 ranges_from_anti_range (value_range_t *ar,
2028 value_range_t *vr0, value_range_t *vr1)
2030 tree type = TREE_TYPE (ar->min);
2032 vr0->type = VR_UNDEFINED;
2033 vr1->type = VR_UNDEFINED;
2035 if (ar->type != VR_ANTI_RANGE
2036 || TREE_CODE (ar->min) != INTEGER_CST
2037 || TREE_CODE (ar->max) != INTEGER_CST
2038 || !vrp_val_min (type)
2039 || !vrp_val_max (type))
2040 return false;
2042 if (!vrp_val_is_min (ar->min))
2044 vr0->type = VR_RANGE;
2045 vr0->min = vrp_val_min (type);
2046 vr0->max
2047 = double_int_to_tree (type,
2048 tree_to_double_int (ar->min) - double_int_one);
2050 if (!vrp_val_is_max (ar->max))
2052 vr1->type = VR_RANGE;
2053 vr1->min
2054 = double_int_to_tree (type,
2055 tree_to_double_int (ar->max) + double_int_one);
2056 vr1->max = vrp_val_max (type);
2058 if (vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
2060 *vr0 = *vr1;
2061 vr1->type = VR_UNDEFINED;
2064 return vr0->type != VR_UNDEFINED;
2067 /* Helper to extract a value-range *VR for a multiplicative operation
2068 *VR0 CODE *VR1. */
2070 static void
2071 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (value_range_t *vr,
2072 enum tree_code code,
2073 value_range_t *vr0, value_range_t *vr1)
2075 enum value_range_type type;
2076 tree val[4];
2077 size_t i;
2078 tree min, max;
2079 bool sop;
2080 int cmp;
2082 /* Multiplications, divisions and shifts are a bit tricky to handle,
2083 depending on the mix of signs we have in the two ranges, we
2084 need to operate on different values to get the minimum and
2085 maximum values for the new range. One approach is to figure
2086 out all the variations of range combinations and do the
2087 operations.
2089 However, this involves several calls to compare_values and it
2090 is pretty convoluted. It's simpler to do the 4 operations
2091 (MIN0 OP MIN1, MIN0 OP MAX1, MAX0 OP MIN1 and MAX0 OP MAX0 OP
2092 MAX1) and then figure the smallest and largest values to form
2093 the new range. */
2094 gcc_assert (code == MULT_EXPR
2095 || code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2096 || code == FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2097 || code == CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2098 || code == EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2099 || code == ROUND_DIV_EXPR
2100 || code == RSHIFT_EXPR
2101 || code == LSHIFT_EXPR);
2102 gcc_assert ((vr0->type == VR_RANGE
2103 || (code == MULT_EXPR && vr0->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE))
2104 && vr0->type == vr1->type);
2106 type = vr0->type;
2108 /* Compute the 4 cross operations. */
2109 sop = false;
2110 val[0] = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0->min, vr1->min);
2111 if (val[0] == NULL_TREE)
2112 sop = true;
2114 if (vr1->max == vr1->min)
2115 val[1] = NULL_TREE;
2116 else
2118 val[1] = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0->min, vr1->max);
2119 if (val[1] == NULL_TREE)
2120 sop = true;
2123 if (vr0->max == vr0->min)
2124 val[2] = NULL_TREE;
2125 else
2127 val[2] = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0->max, vr1->min);
2128 if (val[2] == NULL_TREE)
2129 sop = true;
2132 if (vr0->min == vr0->max || vr1->min == vr1->max)
2133 val[3] = NULL_TREE;
2134 else
2136 val[3] = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0->max, vr1->max);
2137 if (val[3] == NULL_TREE)
2138 sop = true;
2141 if (sop)
2143 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2144 return;
2147 /* Set MIN to the minimum of VAL[i] and MAX to the maximum
2148 of VAL[i]. */
2149 min = val[0];
2150 max = val[0];
2151 for (i = 1; i < 4; i++)
2153 if (!is_gimple_min_invariant (min)
2154 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (min) && !is_overflow_infinity (min))
2155 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (max)
2156 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (max) && !is_overflow_infinity (max)))
2157 break;
2159 if (val[i])
2161 if (!is_gimple_min_invariant (val[i])
2162 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (val[i])
2163 && !is_overflow_infinity (val[i])))
2165 /* If we found an overflowed value, set MIN and MAX
2166 to it so that we set the resulting range to
2167 VARYING. */
2168 min = max = val[i];
2169 break;
2172 if (compare_values (val[i], min) == -1)
2173 min = val[i];
2175 if (compare_values (val[i], max) == 1)
2176 max = val[i];
2180 /* If either MIN or MAX overflowed, then set the resulting range to
2181 VARYING. But we do accept an overflow infinity
2182 representation. */
2183 if (min == NULL_TREE
2184 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (min)
2185 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (min) && !is_overflow_infinity (min))
2186 || max == NULL_TREE
2187 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (max)
2188 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (max) && !is_overflow_infinity (max)))
2190 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2191 return;
2194 /* We punt if:
2195 1) [-INF, +INF]
2196 2) [-INF, +-INF(OVF)]
2197 3) [+-INF(OVF), +INF]
2198 4) [+-INF(OVF), +-INF(OVF)]
2199 We learn nothing when we have INF and INF(OVF) on both sides.
2200 Note that we do accept [-INF, -INF] and [+INF, +INF] without
2201 overflow. */
2202 if ((vrp_val_is_min (min) || is_overflow_infinity (min))
2203 && (vrp_val_is_max (max) || is_overflow_infinity (max)))
2205 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2206 return;
2209 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
2210 if (cmp == -2 || cmp == 1)
2212 /* If the new range has its limits swapped around (MIN > MAX),
2213 then the operation caused one of them to wrap around, mark
2214 the new range VARYING. */
2215 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2217 else
2218 set_value_range (vr, type, min, max, NULL);
2221 /* Some quadruple precision helpers. */
2222 static int
2223 quad_int_cmp (double_int l0, double_int h0,
2224 double_int l1, double_int h1, bool uns)
2226 int c = h0.cmp (h1, uns);
2227 if (c != 0) return c;
2228 return l0.ucmp (l1);
2231 static void
2232 quad_int_pair_sort (double_int *l0, double_int *h0,
2233 double_int *l1, double_int *h1, bool uns)
2235 if (quad_int_cmp (*l0, *h0, *l1, *h1, uns) > 0)
2237 double_int tmp;
2238 tmp = *l0; *l0 = *l1; *l1 = tmp;
2239 tmp = *h0; *h0 = *h1; *h1 = tmp;
2243 /* Extract range information from a binary operation CODE based on
2244 the ranges of each of its operands, *VR0 and *VR1 with resulting
2245 type EXPR_TYPE. The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
2247 static void
2248 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (value_range_t *vr,
2249 enum tree_code code, tree expr_type,
2250 value_range_t *vr0_, value_range_t *vr1_)
2252 value_range_t vr0 = *vr0_, vr1 = *vr1_;
2253 value_range_t vrtem0 = VR_INITIALIZER, vrtem1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
2254 enum value_range_type type;
2255 tree min = NULL_TREE, max = NULL_TREE;
2256 int cmp;
2258 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (expr_type)
2259 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (expr_type))
2261 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2262 return;
2265 /* Not all binary expressions can be applied to ranges in a
2266 meaningful way. Handle only arithmetic operations. */
2267 if (code != PLUS_EXPR
2268 && code != MINUS_EXPR
2269 && code != POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
2270 && code != MULT_EXPR
2271 && code != TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2272 && code != FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2273 && code != CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2274 && code != EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2275 && code != ROUND_DIV_EXPR
2276 && code != TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
2277 && code != RSHIFT_EXPR
2278 && code != LSHIFT_EXPR
2279 && code != MIN_EXPR
2280 && code != MAX_EXPR
2281 && code != BIT_AND_EXPR
2282 && code != BIT_IOR_EXPR
2283 && code != BIT_XOR_EXPR)
2285 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2286 return;
2289 /* If both ranges are UNDEFINED, so is the result. */
2290 if (vr0.type == VR_UNDEFINED && vr1.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
2292 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr);
2293 return;
2295 /* If one of the ranges is UNDEFINED drop it to VARYING for the following
2296 code. At some point we may want to special-case operations that
2297 have UNDEFINED result for all or some value-ranges of the not UNDEFINED
2298 operand. */
2299 else if (vr0.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
2300 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0);
2301 else if (vr1.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
2302 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1);
2304 /* Now canonicalize anti-ranges to ranges when they are not symbolic
2305 and express ~[] op X as ([]' op X) U ([]'' op X). */
2306 if (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
2307 && ranges_from_anti_range (&vr0, &vrtem0, &vrtem1))
2309 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, code, expr_type, &vrtem0, vr1_);
2310 if (vrtem1.type != VR_UNDEFINED)
2312 value_range_t vrres = VR_INITIALIZER;
2313 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (&vrres, code, expr_type,
2314 &vrtem1, vr1_);
2315 vrp_meet (vr, &vrres);
2317 return;
2319 /* Likewise for X op ~[]. */
2320 if (vr1.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
2321 && ranges_from_anti_range (&vr1, &vrtem0, &vrtem1))
2323 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, code, expr_type, vr0_, &vrtem0);
2324 if (vrtem1.type != VR_UNDEFINED)
2326 value_range_t vrres = VR_INITIALIZER;
2327 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (&vrres, code, expr_type,
2328 vr0_, &vrtem1);
2329 vrp_meet (vr, &vrres);
2331 return;
2334 /* The type of the resulting value range defaults to VR0.TYPE. */
2335 type = vr0.type;
2337 /* Refuse to operate on VARYING ranges, ranges of different kinds
2338 and symbolic ranges. As an exception, we allow BIT_AND_EXPR
2339 because we may be able to derive a useful range even if one of
2340 the operands is VR_VARYING or symbolic range. Similarly for
2341 divisions. TODO, we may be able to derive anti-ranges in
2342 some cases. */
2343 if (code != BIT_AND_EXPR
2344 && code != BIT_IOR_EXPR
2345 && code != TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2346 && code != FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2347 && code != CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2348 && code != EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2349 && code != ROUND_DIV_EXPR
2350 && code != TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
2351 && code != MIN_EXPR
2352 && code != MAX_EXPR
2353 && (vr0.type == VR_VARYING
2354 || vr1.type == VR_VARYING
2355 || vr0.type != vr1.type
2356 || symbolic_range_p (&vr0)
2357 || symbolic_range_p (&vr1)))
2359 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2360 return;
2363 /* Now evaluate the expression to determine the new range. */
2364 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (expr_type))
2366 if (code == MIN_EXPR || code == MAX_EXPR)
2368 /* For MIN/MAX expressions with pointers, we only care about
2369 nullness, if both are non null, then the result is nonnull.
2370 If both are null, then the result is null. Otherwise they
2371 are varying. */
2372 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0) && range_is_nonnull (&vr1))
2373 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, expr_type);
2374 else if (range_is_null (&vr0) && range_is_null (&vr1))
2375 set_value_range_to_null (vr, expr_type);
2376 else
2377 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2379 else if (code == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
2381 /* For pointer types, we are really only interested in asserting
2382 whether the expression evaluates to non-NULL. */
2383 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0) || range_is_nonnull (&vr1))
2384 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, expr_type);
2385 else if (range_is_null (&vr0) && range_is_null (&vr1))
2386 set_value_range_to_null (vr, expr_type);
2387 else
2388 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2390 else if (code == BIT_AND_EXPR)
2392 /* For pointer types, we are really only interested in asserting
2393 whether the expression evaluates to non-NULL. */
2394 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0) && range_is_nonnull (&vr1))
2395 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, expr_type);
2396 else if (range_is_null (&vr0) || range_is_null (&vr1))
2397 set_value_range_to_null (vr, expr_type);
2398 else
2399 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2401 else
2402 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2404 return;
2407 /* For integer ranges, apply the operation to each end of the
2408 range and see what we end up with. */
2409 if (code == PLUS_EXPR || code == MINUS_EXPR)
2411 /* If we have a PLUS_EXPR with two VR_RANGE integer constant
2412 ranges compute the precise range for such case if possible. */
2413 if (range_int_cst_p (&vr0)
2414 && range_int_cst_p (&vr1)
2415 /* We need as many bits as the possibly unsigned inputs. */
2416 && TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type) <= HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT)
2418 double_int min0 = tree_to_double_int (vr0.min);
2419 double_int max0 = tree_to_double_int (vr0.max);
2420 double_int min1 = tree_to_double_int (vr1.min);
2421 double_int max1 = tree_to_double_int (vr1.max);
2422 bool uns = TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type);
2423 double_int type_min
2424 = double_int::min_value (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type), uns);
2425 double_int type_max
2426 = double_int::max_value (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type), uns);
2427 double_int dmin, dmax;
2428 int min_ovf = 0;
2429 int max_ovf = 0;
2431 if (code == PLUS_EXPR)
2433 dmin = min0 + min1;
2434 dmax = max0 + max1;
2436 /* Check for overflow in double_int. */
2437 if (min1.cmp (double_int_zero, uns) != dmin.cmp (min0, uns))
2438 min_ovf = min0.cmp (dmin, uns);
2439 if (max1.cmp (double_int_zero, uns) != dmax.cmp (max0, uns))
2440 max_ovf = max0.cmp (dmax, uns);
2442 else /* if (code == MINUS_EXPR) */
2444 dmin = min0 - max1;
2445 dmax = max0 - min1;
2447 if (double_int_zero.cmp (max1, uns) != dmin.cmp (min0, uns))
2448 min_ovf = min0.cmp (max1, uns);
2449 if (double_int_zero.cmp (min1, uns) != dmax.cmp (max0, uns))
2450 max_ovf = max0.cmp (min1, uns);
2453 /* For non-wrapping arithmetic look at possibly smaller
2454 value-ranges of the type. */
2455 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (expr_type))
2457 if (vrp_val_min (expr_type))
2458 type_min = tree_to_double_int (vrp_val_min (expr_type));
2459 if (vrp_val_max (expr_type))
2460 type_max = tree_to_double_int (vrp_val_max (expr_type));
2463 /* Check for type overflow. */
2464 if (min_ovf == 0)
2466 if (dmin.cmp (type_min, uns) == -1)
2467 min_ovf = -1;
2468 else if (dmin.cmp (type_max, uns) == 1)
2469 min_ovf = 1;
2471 if (max_ovf == 0)
2473 if (dmax.cmp (type_min, uns) == -1)
2474 max_ovf = -1;
2475 else if (dmax.cmp (type_max, uns) == 1)
2476 max_ovf = 1;
2479 if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (expr_type))
2481 /* If overflow wraps, truncate the values and adjust the
2482 range kind and bounds appropriately. */
2483 double_int tmin
2484 = dmin.ext (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type), uns);
2485 double_int tmax
2486 = dmax.ext (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type), uns);
2487 if (min_ovf == max_ovf)
2489 /* No overflow or both overflow or underflow. The
2490 range kind stays VR_RANGE. */
2491 min = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, tmin);
2492 max = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, tmax);
2494 else if (min_ovf == -1
2495 && max_ovf == 1)
2497 /* Underflow and overflow, drop to VR_VARYING. */
2498 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2499 return;
2501 else
2503 /* Min underflow or max overflow. The range kind
2504 changes to VR_ANTI_RANGE. */
2505 bool covers = false;
2506 double_int tem = tmin;
2507 gcc_assert ((min_ovf == -1 && max_ovf == 0)
2508 || (max_ovf == 1 && min_ovf == 0));
2509 type = VR_ANTI_RANGE;
2510 tmin = tmax + double_int_one;
2511 if (tmin.cmp (tmax, uns) < 0)
2512 covers = true;
2513 tmax = tem + double_int_minus_one;
2514 if (tmax.cmp (tem, uns) > 0)
2515 covers = true;
2516 /* If the anti-range would cover nothing, drop to varying.
2517 Likewise if the anti-range bounds are outside of the
2518 types values. */
2519 if (covers || tmin.cmp (tmax, uns) > 0)
2521 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2522 return;
2524 min = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, tmin);
2525 max = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, tmax);
2528 else
2530 /* If overflow does not wrap, saturate to the types min/max
2531 value. */
2532 if (min_ovf == -1)
2534 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2535 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2536 min = negative_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2537 else
2538 min = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, type_min);
2540 else if (min_ovf == 1)
2542 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2543 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2544 min = positive_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2545 else
2546 min = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, type_max);
2548 else
2549 min = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, dmin);
2551 if (max_ovf == -1)
2553 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2554 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2555 max = negative_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2556 else
2557 max = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, type_min);
2559 else if (max_ovf == 1)
2561 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2562 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2563 max = positive_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2564 else
2565 max = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, type_max);
2567 else
2568 max = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, dmax);
2570 if (needs_overflow_infinity (expr_type)
2571 && supports_overflow_infinity (expr_type))
2573 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr0.min)
2574 || (code == PLUS_EXPR
2575 ? is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr1.min)
2576 : is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr1.max)))
2577 min = negative_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2578 if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr0.max)
2579 || (code == PLUS_EXPR
2580 ? is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr1.max)
2581 : is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr1.min)))
2582 max = positive_overflow_infinity (expr_type);
2585 else
2587 /* For other cases, for example if we have a PLUS_EXPR with two
2588 VR_ANTI_RANGEs, drop to VR_VARYING. It would take more effort
2589 to compute a precise range for such a case.
2590 ??? General even mixed range kind operations can be expressed
2591 by for example transforming ~[3, 5] + [1, 2] to range-only
2592 operations and a union primitive:
2593 [-INF, 2] + [1, 2] U [5, +INF] + [1, 2]
2594 [-INF+1, 4] U [6, +INF(OVF)]
2595 though usually the union is not exactly representable with
2596 a single range or anti-range as the above is
2597 [-INF+1, +INF(OVF)] intersected with ~[5, 5]
2598 but one could use a scheme similar to equivalences for this. */
2599 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2600 return;
2603 else if (code == MIN_EXPR
2604 || code == MAX_EXPR)
2606 if (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
2607 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr0))
2609 type = VR_RANGE;
2610 if (vr1.type == VR_RANGE
2611 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1))
2613 /* For operations that make the resulting range directly
2614 proportional to the original ranges, apply the operation to
2615 the same end of each range. */
2616 min = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0.min, vr1.min);
2617 max = vrp_int_const_binop (code, vr0.max, vr1.max);
2619 else if (code == MIN_EXPR)
2621 min = vrp_val_min (expr_type);
2622 max = vr0.max;
2624 else if (code == MAX_EXPR)
2626 min = vr0.min;
2627 max = vrp_val_max (expr_type);
2630 else if (vr1.type == VR_RANGE
2631 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1))
2633 type = VR_RANGE;
2634 if (code == MIN_EXPR)
2636 min = vrp_val_min (expr_type);
2637 max = vr1.max;
2639 else if (code == MAX_EXPR)
2641 min = vr1.min;
2642 max = vrp_val_max (expr_type);
2645 else
2647 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2648 return;
2651 else if (code == MULT_EXPR)
2653 /* Fancy code so that with unsigned, [-3,-1]*[-3,-1] does not
2654 drop to varying. */
2655 if (range_int_cst_p (&vr0)
2656 && range_int_cst_p (&vr1)
2657 && TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (expr_type))
2659 double_int min0, max0, min1, max1, sizem1, size;
2660 double_int prod0l, prod0h, prod1l, prod1h,
2661 prod2l, prod2h, prod3l, prod3h;
2662 bool uns0, uns1, uns;
2664 sizem1 = double_int::max_value (TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type), true);
2665 size = sizem1 + double_int_one;
2667 min0 = tree_to_double_int (vr0.min);
2668 max0 = tree_to_double_int (vr0.max);
2669 min1 = tree_to_double_int (vr1.min);
2670 max1 = tree_to_double_int (vr1.max);
2672 uns0 = TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type);
2673 uns1 = uns0;
2675 /* Canonicalize the intervals. */
2676 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type))
2678 double_int min2 = size - min0;
2679 if (!min2.is_zero () && min2.cmp (max0, true) < 0)
2681 min0 = -min2;
2682 max0 -= size;
2683 uns0 = false;
2686 min2 = size - min1;
2687 if (!min2.is_zero () && min2.cmp (max1, true) < 0)
2689 min1 = -min2;
2690 max1 -= size;
2691 uns1 = false;
2694 uns = uns0 & uns1;
2696 bool overflow;
2697 prod0l = min0.wide_mul_with_sign (min1, true, &prod0h, &overflow);
2698 if (!uns0 && min0.is_negative ())
2699 prod0h -= min1;
2700 if (!uns1 && min1.is_negative ())
2701 prod0h -= min0;
2703 prod1l = min0.wide_mul_with_sign (max1, true, &prod1h, &overflow);
2704 if (!uns0 && min0.is_negative ())
2705 prod1h -= max1;
2706 if (!uns1 && max1.is_negative ())
2707 prod1h -= min0;
2709 prod2l = max0.wide_mul_with_sign (min1, true, &prod2h, &overflow);
2710 if (!uns0 && max0.is_negative ())
2711 prod2h -= min1;
2712 if (!uns1 && min1.is_negative ())
2713 prod2h -= max0;
2715 prod3l = max0.wide_mul_with_sign (max1, true, &prod3h, &overflow);
2716 if (!uns0 && max0.is_negative ())
2717 prod3h -= max1;
2718 if (!uns1 && max1.is_negative ())
2719 prod3h -= max0;
2721 /* Sort the 4 products. */
2722 quad_int_pair_sort (&prod0l, &prod0h, &prod3l, &prod3h, uns);
2723 quad_int_pair_sort (&prod1l, &prod1h, &prod2l, &prod2h, uns);
2724 quad_int_pair_sort (&prod0l, &prod0h, &prod1l, &prod1h, uns);
2725 quad_int_pair_sort (&prod2l, &prod2h, &prod3l, &prod3h, uns);
2727 /* Max - min. */
2728 if (prod0l.is_zero ())
2730 prod1l = double_int_zero;
2731 prod1h = -prod0h;
2733 else
2735 prod1l = -prod0l;
2736 prod1h = ~prod0h;
2738 prod2l = prod3l + prod1l;
2739 prod2h = prod3h + prod1h;
2740 if (prod2l.ult (prod3l))
2741 prod2h += double_int_one; /* carry */
2743 if (!prod2h.is_zero ()
2744 || prod2l.cmp (sizem1, true) >= 0)
2746 /* the range covers all values. */
2747 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2748 return;
2751 /* The following should handle the wrapping and selecting
2752 VR_ANTI_RANGE for us. */
2753 min = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, prod0l);
2754 max = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, prod3l);
2755 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, min, max, NULL);
2756 return;
2759 /* If we have an unsigned MULT_EXPR with two VR_ANTI_RANGEs,
2760 drop to VR_VARYING. It would take more effort to compute a
2761 precise range for such a case. For example, if we have
2762 op0 == 65536 and op1 == 65536 with their ranges both being
2763 ~[0,0] on a 32-bit machine, we would have op0 * op1 == 0, so
2764 we cannot claim that the product is in ~[0,0]. Note that we
2765 are guaranteed to have vr0.type == vr1.type at this
2766 point. */
2767 if (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
2768 && !TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (expr_type))
2770 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2771 return;
2774 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr, code, &vr0, &vr1);
2775 return;
2777 else if (code == RSHIFT_EXPR
2778 || code == LSHIFT_EXPR)
2780 /* If we have a RSHIFT_EXPR with any shift values outside [0..prec-1],
2781 then drop to VR_VARYING. Outside of this range we get undefined
2782 behavior from the shift operation. We cannot even trust
2783 SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED at this stage, because that applies to rtl
2784 shifts, and the operation at the tree level may be widened. */
2785 if (range_int_cst_p (&vr1)
2786 && compare_tree_int (vr1.min, 0) >= 0
2787 && compare_tree_int (vr1.max, TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type)) == -1)
2789 if (code == RSHIFT_EXPR)
2791 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr, code, &vr0, &vr1);
2792 return;
2794 /* We can map lshifts by constants to MULT_EXPR handling. */
2795 else if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR
2796 && range_int_cst_singleton_p (&vr1))
2798 bool saved_flag_wrapv;
2799 value_range_t vr1p = VR_INITIALIZER;
2800 vr1p.type = VR_RANGE;
2801 vr1p.min
2802 = double_int_to_tree (expr_type,
2803 double_int_one
2804 .llshift (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (vr1.min),
2805 TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type)));
2806 vr1p.max = vr1p.min;
2807 /* We have to use a wrapping multiply though as signed overflow
2808 on lshifts is implementation defined in C89. */
2809 saved_flag_wrapv = flag_wrapv;
2810 flag_wrapv = 1;
2811 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, MULT_EXPR, expr_type,
2812 &vr0, &vr1p);
2813 flag_wrapv = saved_flag_wrapv;
2814 return;
2816 else if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR
2817 && range_int_cst_p (&vr0))
2819 int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (expr_type);
2820 int overflow_pos = prec;
2821 int bound_shift;
2822 double_int bound, complement, low_bound, high_bound;
2823 bool uns = TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type);
2824 bool in_bounds = false;
2826 if (!uns)
2827 overflow_pos -= 1;
2829 bound_shift = overflow_pos - TREE_INT_CST_LOW (vr1.max);
2830 /* If bound_shift == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT, the llshift can
2831 overflow. However, for that to happen, vr1.max needs to be
2832 zero, which means vr1 is a singleton range of zero, which
2833 means it should be handled by the previous LSHIFT_EXPR
2834 if-clause. */
2835 bound = double_int_one.llshift (bound_shift, prec);
2836 complement = ~(bound - double_int_one);
2838 if (uns)
2840 low_bound = bound.zext (prec);
2841 high_bound = complement.zext (prec);
2842 if (tree_to_double_int (vr0.max).ult (low_bound))
2844 /* [5, 6] << [1, 2] == [10, 24]. */
2845 /* We're shifting out only zeroes, the value increases
2846 monotonically. */
2847 in_bounds = true;
2849 else if (high_bound.ult (tree_to_double_int (vr0.min)))
2851 /* [0xffffff00, 0xffffffff] << [1, 2]
2852 == [0xfffffc00, 0xfffffffe]. */
2853 /* We're shifting out only ones, the value decreases
2854 monotonically. */
2855 in_bounds = true;
2858 else
2860 /* [-1, 1] << [1, 2] == [-4, 4]. */
2861 low_bound = complement.sext (prec);
2862 high_bound = bound;
2863 if (tree_to_double_int (vr0.max).slt (high_bound)
2864 && low_bound.slt (tree_to_double_int (vr0.min)))
2866 /* For non-negative numbers, we're shifting out only
2867 zeroes, the value increases monotonically.
2868 For negative numbers, we're shifting out only ones, the
2869 value decreases monotomically. */
2870 in_bounds = true;
2874 if (in_bounds)
2876 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr, code, &vr0, &vr1);
2877 return;
2881 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2882 return;
2884 else if (code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
2885 || code == FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
2886 || code == CEIL_DIV_EXPR
2887 || code == EXACT_DIV_EXPR
2888 || code == ROUND_DIV_EXPR)
2890 if (vr0.type != VR_RANGE || symbolic_range_p (&vr0))
2892 /* For division, if op1 has VR_RANGE but op0 does not, something
2893 can be deduced just from that range. Say [min, max] / [4, max]
2894 gives [min / 4, max / 4] range. */
2895 if (vr1.type == VR_RANGE
2896 && !symbolic_range_p (&vr1)
2897 && range_includes_zero_p (vr1.min, vr1.max) == 0)
2899 vr0.type = type = VR_RANGE;
2900 vr0.min = vrp_val_min (expr_type);
2901 vr0.max = vrp_val_max (expr_type);
2903 else
2905 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2906 return;
2910 /* For divisions, if flag_non_call_exceptions is true, we must
2911 not eliminate a division by zero. */
2912 if (cfun->can_throw_non_call_exceptions
2913 && (vr1.type != VR_RANGE
2914 || range_includes_zero_p (vr1.min, vr1.max) != 0))
2916 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2917 return;
2920 /* For divisions, if op0 is VR_RANGE, we can deduce a range
2921 even if op1 is VR_VARYING, VR_ANTI_RANGE, symbolic or can
2922 include 0. */
2923 if (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
2924 && (vr1.type != VR_RANGE
2925 || range_includes_zero_p (vr1.min, vr1.max) != 0))
2927 tree zero = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (vr0.min), 0);
2928 int cmp;
2930 min = NULL_TREE;
2931 max = NULL_TREE;
2932 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type)
2933 || value_range_nonnegative_p (&vr1))
2935 /* For unsigned division or when divisor is known
2936 to be non-negative, the range has to cover
2937 all numbers from 0 to max for positive max
2938 and all numbers from min to 0 for negative min. */
2939 cmp = compare_values (vr0.max, zero);
2940 if (cmp == -1)
2941 max = zero;
2942 else if (cmp == 0 || cmp == 1)
2943 max = vr0.max;
2944 else
2945 type = VR_VARYING;
2946 cmp = compare_values (vr0.min, zero);
2947 if (cmp == 1)
2948 min = zero;
2949 else if (cmp == 0 || cmp == -1)
2950 min = vr0.min;
2951 else
2952 type = VR_VARYING;
2954 else
2956 /* Otherwise the range is -max .. max or min .. -min
2957 depending on which bound is bigger in absolute value,
2958 as the division can change the sign. */
2959 abs_extent_range (vr, vr0.min, vr0.max);
2960 return;
2962 if (type == VR_VARYING)
2964 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2965 return;
2968 else
2970 extract_range_from_multiplicative_op_1 (vr, code, &vr0, &vr1);
2971 return;
2974 else if (code == TRUNC_MOD_EXPR)
2976 if (vr1.type != VR_RANGE
2977 || range_includes_zero_p (vr1.min, vr1.max) != 0
2978 || vrp_val_is_min (vr1.min))
2980 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
2981 return;
2983 type = VR_RANGE;
2984 /* Compute MAX <|vr1.min|, |vr1.max|> - 1. */
2985 max = fold_unary_to_constant (ABS_EXPR, expr_type, vr1.min);
2986 if (tree_int_cst_lt (max, vr1.max))
2987 max = vr1.max;
2988 max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, max, integer_one_node);
2989 /* If the dividend is non-negative the modulus will be
2990 non-negative as well. */
2991 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type)
2992 || value_range_nonnegative_p (&vr0))
2993 min = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (max), 0);
2994 else
2995 min = fold_unary_to_constant (NEGATE_EXPR, expr_type, max);
2997 else if (code == BIT_AND_EXPR || code == BIT_IOR_EXPR || code == BIT_XOR_EXPR)
2999 bool int_cst_range0, int_cst_range1;
3000 double_int may_be_nonzero0, may_be_nonzero1;
3001 double_int must_be_nonzero0, must_be_nonzero1;
3003 int_cst_range0 = zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (&vr0, &may_be_nonzero0,
3004 &must_be_nonzero0);
3005 int_cst_range1 = zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (&vr1, &may_be_nonzero1,
3006 &must_be_nonzero1);
3008 type = VR_RANGE;
3009 if (code == BIT_AND_EXPR)
3011 double_int dmax;
3012 min = double_int_to_tree (expr_type,
3013 must_be_nonzero0 & must_be_nonzero1);
3014 dmax = may_be_nonzero0 & may_be_nonzero1;
3015 /* If both input ranges contain only negative values we can
3016 truncate the result range maximum to the minimum of the
3017 input range maxima. */
3018 if (int_cst_range0 && int_cst_range1
3019 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0.max) < 0
3020 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1.max) < 0)
3022 dmax = dmax.min (tree_to_double_int (vr0.max),
3023 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type));
3024 dmax = dmax.min (tree_to_double_int (vr1.max),
3025 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type));
3027 /* If either input range contains only non-negative values
3028 we can truncate the result range maximum to the respective
3029 maximum of the input range. */
3030 if (int_cst_range0 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0.min) >= 0)
3031 dmax = dmax.min (tree_to_double_int (vr0.max),
3032 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type));
3033 if (int_cst_range1 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1.min) >= 0)
3034 dmax = dmax.min (tree_to_double_int (vr1.max),
3035 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type));
3036 max = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, dmax);
3038 else if (code == BIT_IOR_EXPR)
3040 double_int dmin;
3041 max = double_int_to_tree (expr_type,
3042 may_be_nonzero0 | may_be_nonzero1);
3043 dmin = must_be_nonzero0 | must_be_nonzero1;
3044 /* If the input ranges contain only positive values we can
3045 truncate the minimum of the result range to the maximum
3046 of the input range minima. */
3047 if (int_cst_range0 && int_cst_range1
3048 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0.min) >= 0
3049 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1.min) >= 0)
3051 dmin = dmin.max (tree_to_double_int (vr0.min),
3052 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type));
3053 dmin = dmin.max (tree_to_double_int (vr1.min),
3054 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type));
3056 /* If either input range contains only negative values
3057 we can truncate the minimum of the result range to the
3058 respective minimum range. */
3059 if (int_cst_range0 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr0.max) < 0)
3060 dmin = dmin.max (tree_to_double_int (vr0.min),
3061 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type));
3062 if (int_cst_range1 && tree_int_cst_sgn (vr1.max) < 0)
3063 dmin = dmin.max (tree_to_double_int (vr1.min),
3064 TYPE_UNSIGNED (expr_type));
3065 min = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, dmin);
3067 else if (code == BIT_XOR_EXPR)
3069 double_int result_zero_bits, result_one_bits;
3070 result_zero_bits = (must_be_nonzero0 & must_be_nonzero1)
3071 | ~(may_be_nonzero0 | may_be_nonzero1);
3072 result_one_bits = must_be_nonzero0.and_not (may_be_nonzero1)
3073 | must_be_nonzero1.and_not (may_be_nonzero0);
3074 max = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, ~result_zero_bits);
3075 min = double_int_to_tree (expr_type, result_one_bits);
3076 /* If the range has all positive or all negative values the
3077 result is better than VARYING. */
3078 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (min) < 0
3079 || tree_int_cst_sgn (max) >= 0)
3081 else
3082 max = min = NULL_TREE;
3085 else
3086 gcc_unreachable ();
3088 /* If either MIN or MAX overflowed, then set the resulting range to
3089 VARYING. But we do accept an overflow infinity
3090 representation. */
3091 if (min == NULL_TREE
3092 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (min)
3093 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (min) && !is_overflow_infinity (min))
3094 || max == NULL_TREE
3095 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (max)
3096 || (TREE_OVERFLOW (max) && !is_overflow_infinity (max)))
3098 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3099 return;
3102 /* We punt if:
3103 1) [-INF, +INF]
3104 2) [-INF, +-INF(OVF)]
3105 3) [+-INF(OVF), +INF]
3106 4) [+-INF(OVF), +-INF(OVF)]
3107 We learn nothing when we have INF and INF(OVF) on both sides.
3108 Note that we do accept [-INF, -INF] and [+INF, +INF] without
3109 overflow. */
3110 if ((vrp_val_is_min (min) || is_overflow_infinity (min))
3111 && (vrp_val_is_max (max) || is_overflow_infinity (max)))
3113 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3114 return;
3117 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
3118 if (cmp == -2 || cmp == 1)
3120 /* If the new range has its limits swapped around (MIN > MAX),
3121 then the operation caused one of them to wrap around, mark
3122 the new range VARYING. */
3123 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3125 else
3126 set_value_range (vr, type, min, max, NULL);
3129 /* Extract range information from a binary expression OP0 CODE OP1 based on
3130 the ranges of each of its operands with resulting type EXPR_TYPE.
3131 The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
3133 static void
3134 extract_range_from_binary_expr (value_range_t *vr,
3135 enum tree_code code,
3136 tree expr_type, tree op0, tree op1)
3138 value_range_t vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3139 value_range_t vr1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3141 /* Get value ranges for each operand. For constant operands, create
3142 a new value range with the operand to simplify processing. */
3143 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
3144 vr0 = *(get_value_range (op0));
3145 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0))
3146 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0, op0, NULL);
3147 else
3148 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0);
3150 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
3151 vr1 = *(get_value_range (op1));
3152 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
3153 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1, op1, NULL);
3154 else
3155 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1);
3157 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, code, expr_type, &vr0, &vr1);
3160 /* Extract range information from a unary operation CODE based on
3161 the range of its operand *VR0 with type OP0_TYPE with resulting type TYPE.
3162 The The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
3164 static void
3165 extract_range_from_unary_expr_1 (value_range_t *vr,
3166 enum tree_code code, tree type,
3167 value_range_t *vr0_, tree op0_type)
3169 value_range_t vr0 = *vr0_, vrtem0 = VR_INITIALIZER, vrtem1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3171 /* VRP only operates on integral and pointer types. */
3172 if (!(INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (op0_type)
3173 || POINTER_TYPE_P (op0_type))
3174 || !(INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
3175 || POINTER_TYPE_P (type)))
3177 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3178 return;
3181 /* If VR0 is UNDEFINED, so is the result. */
3182 if (vr0.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
3184 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr);
3185 return;
3188 /* Handle operations that we express in terms of others. */
3189 if (code == PAREN_EXPR)
3191 /* PAREN_EXPR is a simple copy. */
3192 copy_value_range (vr, &vr0);
3193 return;
3195 else if (code == NEGATE_EXPR)
3197 /* -X is simply 0 - X, so re-use existing code that also handles
3198 anti-ranges fine. */
3199 value_range_t zero = VR_INITIALIZER;
3200 set_value_range_to_value (&zero, build_int_cst (type, 0), NULL);
3201 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, MINUS_EXPR, type, &zero, &vr0);
3202 return;
3204 else if (code == BIT_NOT_EXPR)
3206 /* ~X is simply -1 - X, so re-use existing code that also handles
3207 anti-ranges fine. */
3208 value_range_t minusone = VR_INITIALIZER;
3209 set_value_range_to_value (&minusone, build_int_cst (type, -1), NULL);
3210 extract_range_from_binary_expr_1 (vr, MINUS_EXPR,
3211 type, &minusone, &vr0);
3212 return;
3215 /* Now canonicalize anti-ranges to ranges when they are not symbolic
3216 and express op ~[] as (op []') U (op []''). */
3217 if (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
3218 && ranges_from_anti_range (&vr0, &vrtem0, &vrtem1))
3220 extract_range_from_unary_expr_1 (vr, code, type, &vrtem0, op0_type);
3221 if (vrtem1.type != VR_UNDEFINED)
3223 value_range_t vrres = VR_INITIALIZER;
3224 extract_range_from_unary_expr_1 (&vrres, code, type,
3225 &vrtem1, op0_type);
3226 vrp_meet (vr, &vrres);
3228 return;
3231 if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code))
3233 tree inner_type = op0_type;
3234 tree outer_type = type;
3236 /* If the expression evaluates to a pointer, we are only interested in
3237 determining if it evaluates to NULL [0, 0] or non-NULL (~[0, 0]). */
3238 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type))
3240 if (range_is_nonnull (&vr0))
3241 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, type);
3242 else if (range_is_null (&vr0))
3243 set_value_range_to_null (vr, type);
3244 else
3245 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3246 return;
3249 /* If VR0 is varying and we increase the type precision, assume
3250 a full range for the following transformation. */
3251 if (vr0.type == VR_VARYING
3252 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (inner_type)
3253 && TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type) < TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type))
3255 vr0.type = VR_RANGE;
3256 vr0.min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (inner_type);
3257 vr0.max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (inner_type);
3260 /* If VR0 is a constant range or anti-range and the conversion is
3261 not truncating we can convert the min and max values and
3262 canonicalize the resulting range. Otherwise we can do the
3263 conversion if the size of the range is less than what the
3264 precision of the target type can represent and the range is
3265 not an anti-range. */
3266 if ((vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3267 || vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
3268 && TREE_CODE (vr0.min) == INTEGER_CST
3269 && TREE_CODE (vr0.max) == INTEGER_CST
3270 && (!is_overflow_infinity (vr0.min)
3271 || (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3272 && TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type) > TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type)
3273 && needs_overflow_infinity (outer_type)
3274 && supports_overflow_infinity (outer_type)))
3275 && (!is_overflow_infinity (vr0.max)
3276 || (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3277 && TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type) > TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type)
3278 && needs_overflow_infinity (outer_type)
3279 && supports_overflow_infinity (outer_type)))
3280 && (TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type) >= TYPE_PRECISION (inner_type)
3281 || (vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3282 && integer_zerop (int_const_binop (RSHIFT_EXPR,
3283 int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr0.max, vr0.min),
3284 size_int (TYPE_PRECISION (outer_type)))))))
3286 tree new_min, new_max;
3287 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0.min))
3288 new_min = negative_overflow_infinity (outer_type);
3289 else
3290 new_min = force_fit_type_double (outer_type,
3291 tree_to_double_int (vr0.min),
3292 0, false);
3293 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0.max))
3294 new_max = positive_overflow_infinity (outer_type);
3295 else
3296 new_max = force_fit_type_double (outer_type,
3297 tree_to_double_int (vr0.max),
3298 0, false);
3299 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr, vr0.type,
3300 new_min, new_max, NULL);
3301 return;
3304 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3305 return;
3307 else if (code == ABS_EXPR)
3309 tree min, max;
3310 int cmp;
3312 /* Pass through vr0 in the easy cases. */
3313 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
3314 || value_range_nonnegative_p (&vr0))
3316 copy_value_range (vr, &vr0);
3317 return;
3320 /* For the remaining varying or symbolic ranges we can't do anything
3321 useful. */
3322 if (vr0.type == VR_VARYING
3323 || symbolic_range_p (&vr0))
3325 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3326 return;
3329 /* -TYPE_MIN_VALUE = TYPE_MIN_VALUE with flag_wrapv so we can't get a
3330 useful range. */
3331 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (type)
3332 && ((vr0.type == VR_RANGE
3333 && vrp_val_is_min (vr0.min))
3334 || (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
3335 && !vrp_val_is_min (vr0.min))))
3337 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3338 return;
3341 /* ABS_EXPR may flip the range around, if the original range
3342 included negative values. */
3343 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0.min))
3344 min = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3345 else if (!vrp_val_is_min (vr0.min))
3346 min = fold_unary_to_constant (code, type, vr0.min);
3347 else if (!needs_overflow_infinity (type))
3348 min = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
3349 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (type))
3350 min = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3351 else
3353 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3354 return;
3357 if (is_overflow_infinity (vr0.max))
3358 max = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3359 else if (!vrp_val_is_min (vr0.max))
3360 max = fold_unary_to_constant (code, type, vr0.max);
3361 else if (!needs_overflow_infinity (type))
3362 max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
3363 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (type)
3364 /* We shouldn't generate [+INF, +INF] as set_value_range
3365 doesn't like this and ICEs. */
3366 && !is_positive_overflow_infinity (min))
3367 max = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3368 else
3370 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3371 return;
3374 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
3376 /* If a VR_ANTI_RANGEs contains zero, then we have
3377 ~[-INF, min(MIN, MAX)]. */
3378 if (vr0.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
3380 if (range_includes_zero_p (vr0.min, vr0.max) == 1)
3382 /* Take the lower of the two values. */
3383 if (cmp != 1)
3384 max = min;
3386 /* Create ~[-INF, min (abs(MIN), abs(MAX))]
3387 or ~[-INF + 1, min (abs(MIN), abs(MAX))] when
3388 flag_wrapv is set and the original anti-range doesn't include
3389 TYPE_MIN_VALUE, remember -TYPE_MIN_VALUE = TYPE_MIN_VALUE. */
3390 if (TYPE_OVERFLOW_WRAPS (type))
3392 tree type_min_value = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
3394 min = (vr0.min != type_min_value
3395 ? int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, type_min_value,
3396 integer_one_node)
3397 : type_min_value);
3399 else
3401 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (&vr0))
3402 min = negative_overflow_infinity (type);
3403 else
3404 min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
3407 else
3409 /* All else has failed, so create the range [0, INF], even for
3410 flag_wrapv since TYPE_MIN_VALUE is in the original
3411 anti-range. */
3412 vr0.type = VR_RANGE;
3413 min = build_int_cst (type, 0);
3414 if (needs_overflow_infinity (type))
3416 if (supports_overflow_infinity (type))
3417 max = positive_overflow_infinity (type);
3418 else
3420 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3421 return;
3424 else
3425 max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
3429 /* If the range contains zero then we know that the minimum value in the
3430 range will be zero. */
3431 else if (range_includes_zero_p (vr0.min, vr0.max) == 1)
3433 if (cmp == 1)
3434 max = min;
3435 min = build_int_cst (type, 0);
3437 else
3439 /* If the range was reversed, swap MIN and MAX. */
3440 if (cmp == 1)
3442 tree t = min;
3443 min = max;
3444 max = t;
3448 cmp = compare_values (min, max);
3449 if (cmp == -2 || cmp == 1)
3451 /* If the new range has its limits swapped around (MIN > MAX),
3452 then the operation caused one of them to wrap around, mark
3453 the new range VARYING. */
3454 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3456 else
3457 set_value_range (vr, vr0.type, min, max, NULL);
3458 return;
3461 /* For unhandled operations fall back to varying. */
3462 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3463 return;
3467 /* Extract range information from a unary expression CODE OP0 based on
3468 the range of its operand with resulting type TYPE.
3469 The resulting range is stored in *VR. */
3471 static void
3472 extract_range_from_unary_expr (value_range_t *vr, enum tree_code code,
3473 tree type, tree op0)
3475 value_range_t vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3477 /* Get value ranges for the operand. For constant operands, create
3478 a new value range with the operand to simplify processing. */
3479 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
3480 vr0 = *(get_value_range (op0));
3481 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0))
3482 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0, op0, NULL);
3483 else
3484 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0);
3486 extract_range_from_unary_expr_1 (vr, code, type, &vr0, TREE_TYPE (op0));
3490 /* Extract range information from a conditional expression STMT based on
3491 the ranges of each of its operands and the expression code. */
3493 static void
3494 extract_range_from_cond_expr (value_range_t *vr, gimple stmt)
3496 tree op0, op1;
3497 value_range_t vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3498 value_range_t vr1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
3500 /* Get value ranges for each operand. For constant operands, create
3501 a new value range with the operand to simplify processing. */
3502 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
3503 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
3504 vr0 = *(get_value_range (op0));
3505 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0))
3506 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0, op0, NULL);
3507 else
3508 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr0);
3510 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs3 (stmt);
3511 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
3512 vr1 = *(get_value_range (op1));
3513 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
3514 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1, op1, NULL);
3515 else
3516 set_value_range_to_varying (&vr1);
3518 /* The resulting value range is the union of the operand ranges */
3519 copy_value_range (vr, &vr0);
3520 vrp_meet (vr, &vr1);
3524 /* Extract range information from a comparison expression EXPR based
3525 on the range of its operand and the expression code. */
3527 static void
3528 extract_range_from_comparison (value_range_t *vr, enum tree_code code,
3529 tree type, tree op0, tree op1)
3531 bool sop = false;
3532 tree val;
3534 val = vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (code, op0, op1, false, &sop,
3535 NULL);
3537 /* A disadvantage of using a special infinity as an overflow
3538 representation is that we lose the ability to record overflow
3539 when we don't have an infinity. So we have to ignore a result
3540 which relies on overflow. */
3542 if (val && !is_overflow_infinity (val) && !sop)
3544 /* Since this expression was found on the RHS of an assignment,
3545 its type may be different from _Bool. Convert VAL to EXPR's
3546 type. */
3547 val = fold_convert (type, val);
3548 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (val))
3549 set_value_range_to_value (vr, val, vr->equiv);
3550 else
3551 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, val, val, vr->equiv);
3553 else
3554 /* The result of a comparison is always true or false. */
3555 set_value_range_to_truthvalue (vr, type);
3558 /* Try to derive a nonnegative or nonzero range out of STMT relying
3559 primarily on generic routines in fold in conjunction with range data.
3560 Store the result in *VR */
3562 static void
3563 extract_range_basic (value_range_t *vr, gimple stmt)
3565 bool sop = false;
3566 tree type = gimple_expr_type (stmt);
3568 /* If the call is __builtin_constant_p and the argument is a
3569 function parameter resolve it to false. This avoids bogus
3570 array bound warnings.
3571 ??? We could do this as early as inlining is finished. */
3572 if (gimple_call_builtin_p (stmt, BUILT_IN_CONSTANT_P))
3574 tree arg = gimple_call_arg (stmt, 0);
3575 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME
3576 && SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (arg)
3577 && TREE_CODE (SSA_NAME_VAR (arg)) == PARM_DECL)
3578 set_value_range_to_null (vr, type);
3580 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
3581 && gimple_stmt_nonnegative_warnv_p (stmt, &sop))
3582 set_value_range_to_nonnegative (vr, type,
3583 sop || stmt_overflow_infinity (stmt));
3584 else if (vrp_stmt_computes_nonzero (stmt, &sop)
3585 && !sop)
3586 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr, type);
3587 else
3588 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3592 /* Try to compute a useful range out of assignment STMT and store it
3593 in *VR. */
3595 static void
3596 extract_range_from_assignment (value_range_t *vr, gimple stmt)
3598 enum tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
3600 if (code == ASSERT_EXPR)
3601 extract_range_from_assert (vr, gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
3602 else if (code == SSA_NAME)
3603 extract_range_from_ssa_name (vr, gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
3604 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary)
3605 extract_range_from_binary_expr (vr, gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
3606 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
3607 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
3608 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt));
3609 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary)
3610 extract_range_from_unary_expr (vr, gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
3611 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
3612 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
3613 else if (code == COND_EXPR)
3614 extract_range_from_cond_expr (vr, stmt);
3615 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison)
3616 extract_range_from_comparison (vr, gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
3617 gimple_expr_type (stmt),
3618 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
3619 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt));
3620 else if (get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS
3621 && is_gimple_min_invariant (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt)))
3622 set_value_range_to_value (vr, gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt), NULL);
3623 else
3624 set_value_range_to_varying (vr);
3626 if (vr->type == VR_VARYING)
3627 extract_range_basic (vr, stmt);
3630 /* Given a range VR, a LOOP and a variable VAR, determine whether it
3631 would be profitable to adjust VR using scalar evolution information
3632 for VAR. If so, update VR with the new limits. */
3634 static void
3635 adjust_range_with_scev (value_range_t *vr, struct loop *loop,
3636 gimple stmt, tree var)
3638 tree init, step, chrec, tmin, tmax, min, max, type, tem;
3639 enum ev_direction dir;
3641 /* TODO. Don't adjust anti-ranges. An anti-range may provide
3642 better opportunities than a regular range, but I'm not sure. */
3643 if (vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
3644 return;
3646 chrec = instantiate_parameters (loop, analyze_scalar_evolution (loop, var));
3648 /* Like in PR19590, scev can return a constant function. */
3649 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (chrec))
3651 set_value_range_to_value (vr, chrec, vr->equiv);
3652 return;
3655 if (TREE_CODE (chrec) != POLYNOMIAL_CHREC)
3656 return;
3658 init = initial_condition_in_loop_num (chrec, loop->num);
3659 tem = op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (init);
3660 if (tem)
3661 init = tem;
3662 step = evolution_part_in_loop_num (chrec, loop->num);
3663 tem = op_with_constant_singleton_value_range (step);
3664 if (tem)
3665 step = tem;
3667 /* If STEP is symbolic, we can't know whether INIT will be the
3668 minimum or maximum value in the range. Also, unless INIT is
3669 a simple expression, compare_values and possibly other functions
3670 in tree-vrp won't be able to handle it. */
3671 if (step == NULL_TREE
3672 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (step)
3673 || !valid_value_p (init))
3674 return;
3676 dir = scev_direction (chrec);
3677 if (/* Do not adjust ranges if we do not know whether the iv increases
3678 or decreases, ... */
3679 dir == EV_DIR_UNKNOWN
3680 /* ... or if it may wrap. */
3681 || scev_probably_wraps_p (init, step, stmt, get_chrec_loop (chrec),
3682 true))
3683 return;
3685 /* We use TYPE_MIN_VALUE and TYPE_MAX_VALUE here instead of
3686 negative_overflow_infinity and positive_overflow_infinity,
3687 because we have concluded that the loop probably does not
3688 wrap. */
3690 type = TREE_TYPE (var);
3691 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type) || !TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type))
3692 tmin = lower_bound_in_type (type, type);
3693 else
3694 tmin = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type);
3695 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (type) || !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type))
3696 tmax = upper_bound_in_type (type, type);
3697 else
3698 tmax = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type);
3700 /* Try to use estimated number of iterations for the loop to constrain the
3701 final value in the evolution. */
3702 if (TREE_CODE (step) == INTEGER_CST
3703 && is_gimple_val (init)
3704 && (TREE_CODE (init) != SSA_NAME
3705 || get_value_range (init)->type == VR_RANGE))
3707 double_int nit;
3709 /* We are only entering here for loop header PHI nodes, so using
3710 the number of latch executions is the correct thing to use. */
3711 if (max_loop_iterations (loop, &nit))
3713 value_range_t maxvr = VR_INITIALIZER;
3714 double_int dtmp;
3715 bool unsigned_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (step));
3716 bool overflow = false;
3718 dtmp = tree_to_double_int (step)
3719 .mul_with_sign (nit, unsigned_p, &overflow);
3720 /* If the multiplication overflowed we can't do a meaningful
3721 adjustment. Likewise if the result doesn't fit in the type
3722 of the induction variable. For a signed type we have to
3723 check whether the result has the expected signedness which
3724 is that of the step as number of iterations is unsigned. */
3725 if (!overflow
3726 && double_int_fits_to_tree_p (TREE_TYPE (init), dtmp)
3727 && (unsigned_p
3728 || ((dtmp.high ^ TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (step)) >= 0)))
3730 tem = double_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (init), dtmp);
3731 extract_range_from_binary_expr (&maxvr, PLUS_EXPR,
3732 TREE_TYPE (init), init, tem);
3733 /* Likewise if the addition did. */
3734 if (maxvr.type == VR_RANGE)
3736 tmin = maxvr.min;
3737 tmax = maxvr.max;
3743 if (vr->type == VR_VARYING || vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
3745 min = tmin;
3746 max = tmax;
3748 /* For VARYING or UNDEFINED ranges, just about anything we get
3749 from scalar evolutions should be better. */
3751 if (dir == EV_DIR_DECREASES)
3752 max = init;
3753 else
3754 min = init;
3756 /* If we would create an invalid range, then just assume we
3757 know absolutely nothing. This may be over-conservative,
3758 but it's clearly safe, and should happen only in unreachable
3759 parts of code, or for invalid programs. */
3760 if (compare_values (min, max) == 1)
3761 return;
3763 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, min, max, vr->equiv);
3765 else if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
3767 min = vr->min;
3768 max = vr->max;
3770 if (dir == EV_DIR_DECREASES)
3772 /* INIT is the maximum value. If INIT is lower than VR->MAX
3773 but no smaller than VR->MIN, set VR->MAX to INIT. */
3774 if (compare_values (init, max) == -1)
3775 max = init;
3777 /* According to the loop information, the variable does not
3778 overflow. If we think it does, probably because of an
3779 overflow due to arithmetic on a different INF value,
3780 reset now. */
3781 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (min)
3782 || compare_values (min, tmin) == -1)
3783 min = tmin;
3786 else
3788 /* If INIT is bigger than VR->MIN, set VR->MIN to INIT. */
3789 if (compare_values (init, min) == 1)
3790 min = init;
3792 if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (max)
3793 || compare_values (tmax, max) == -1)
3794 max = tmax;
3797 /* If we just created an invalid range with the minimum
3798 greater than the maximum, we fail conservatively.
3799 This should happen only in unreachable
3800 parts of code, or for invalid programs. */
3801 if (compare_values (min, max) == 1)
3802 return;
3804 set_value_range (vr, VR_RANGE, min, max, vr->equiv);
3808 /* Return true if VAR may overflow at STMT. This checks any available
3809 loop information to see if we can determine that VAR does not
3810 overflow. */
3812 static bool
3813 vrp_var_may_overflow (tree var, gimple stmt)
3815 struct loop *l;
3816 tree chrec, init, step;
3818 if (current_loops == NULL)
3819 return true;
3821 l = loop_containing_stmt (stmt);
3822 if (l == NULL
3823 || !loop_outer (l))
3824 return true;
3826 chrec = instantiate_parameters (l, analyze_scalar_evolution (l, var));
3827 if (TREE_CODE (chrec) != POLYNOMIAL_CHREC)
3828 return true;
3830 init = initial_condition_in_loop_num (chrec, l->num);
3831 step = evolution_part_in_loop_num (chrec, l->num);
3833 if (step == NULL_TREE
3834 || !is_gimple_min_invariant (step)
3835 || !valid_value_p (init))
3836 return true;
3838 /* If we get here, we know something useful about VAR based on the
3839 loop information. If it wraps, it may overflow. */
3841 if (scev_probably_wraps_p (init, step, stmt, get_chrec_loop (chrec),
3842 true))
3843 return true;
3845 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS) != 0)
3847 print_generic_expr (dump_file, var, 0);
3848 fprintf (dump_file, ": loop information indicates does not overflow\n");
3851 return false;
3855 /* Given two numeric value ranges VR0, VR1 and a comparison code COMP:
3857 - Return BOOLEAN_TRUE_NODE if VR0 COMP VR1 always returns true for
3858 all the values in the ranges.
3860 - Return BOOLEAN_FALSE_NODE if the comparison always returns false.
3862 - Return NULL_TREE if it is not always possible to determine the
3863 value of the comparison.
3865 Also set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to indicate whether a range with an
3866 overflow infinity was used in the test. */
3869 static tree
3870 compare_ranges (enum tree_code comp, value_range_t *vr0, value_range_t *vr1,
3871 bool *strict_overflow_p)
3873 /* VARYING or UNDEFINED ranges cannot be compared. */
3874 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING
3875 || vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED
3876 || vr1->type == VR_VARYING
3877 || vr1->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
3878 return NULL_TREE;
3880 /* Anti-ranges need to be handled separately. */
3881 if (vr0->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE || vr1->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
3883 /* If both are anti-ranges, then we cannot compute any
3884 comparison. */
3885 if (vr0->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE && vr1->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
3886 return NULL_TREE;
3888 /* These comparisons are never statically computable. */
3889 if (comp == GT_EXPR
3890 || comp == GE_EXPR
3891 || comp == LT_EXPR
3892 || comp == LE_EXPR)
3893 return NULL_TREE;
3895 /* Equality can be computed only between a range and an
3896 anti-range. ~[VAL1, VAL2] == [VAL1, VAL2] is always false. */
3897 if (vr0->type == VR_RANGE)
3899 /* To simplify processing, make VR0 the anti-range. */
3900 value_range_t *tmp = vr0;
3901 vr0 = vr1;
3902 vr1 = tmp;
3905 gcc_assert (comp == NE_EXPR || comp == EQ_EXPR);
3907 if (compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->min, strict_overflow_p) == 0
3908 && compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0)
3909 return (comp == NE_EXPR) ? boolean_true_node : boolean_false_node;
3911 return NULL_TREE;
3914 if (!usable_range_p (vr0, strict_overflow_p)
3915 || !usable_range_p (vr1, strict_overflow_p))
3916 return NULL_TREE;
3918 /* Simplify processing. If COMP is GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR, switch the
3919 operands around and change the comparison code. */
3920 if (comp == GT_EXPR || comp == GE_EXPR)
3922 value_range_t *tmp;
3923 comp = (comp == GT_EXPR) ? LT_EXPR : LE_EXPR;
3924 tmp = vr0;
3925 vr0 = vr1;
3926 vr1 = tmp;
3929 if (comp == EQ_EXPR)
3931 /* Equality may only be computed if both ranges represent
3932 exactly one value. */
3933 if (compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr0->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0
3934 && compare_values_warnv (vr1->min, vr1->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0)
3936 int cmp_min = compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->min,
3937 strict_overflow_p);
3938 int cmp_max = compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->max,
3939 strict_overflow_p);
3940 if (cmp_min == 0 && cmp_max == 0)
3941 return boolean_true_node;
3942 else if (cmp_min != -2 && cmp_max != -2)
3943 return boolean_false_node;
3945 /* If [V0_MIN, V1_MAX] < [V1_MIN, V1_MAX] then V0 != V1. */
3946 else if (compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->max,
3947 strict_overflow_p) == 1
3948 || compare_values_warnv (vr1->min, vr0->max,
3949 strict_overflow_p) == 1)
3950 return boolean_false_node;
3952 return NULL_TREE;
3954 else if (comp == NE_EXPR)
3956 int cmp1, cmp2;
3958 /* If VR0 is completely to the left or completely to the right
3959 of VR1, they are always different. Notice that we need to
3960 make sure that both comparisons yield similar results to
3961 avoid comparing values that cannot be compared at
3962 compile-time. */
3963 cmp1 = compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->min, strict_overflow_p);
3964 cmp2 = compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->max, strict_overflow_p);
3965 if ((cmp1 == -1 && cmp2 == -1) || (cmp1 == 1 && cmp2 == 1))
3966 return boolean_true_node;
3968 /* If VR0 and VR1 represent a single value and are identical,
3969 return false. */
3970 else if (compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr0->max,
3971 strict_overflow_p) == 0
3972 && compare_values_warnv (vr1->min, vr1->max,
3973 strict_overflow_p) == 0
3974 && compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->min,
3975 strict_overflow_p) == 0
3976 && compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->max,
3977 strict_overflow_p) == 0)
3978 return boolean_false_node;
3980 /* Otherwise, they may or may not be different. */
3981 else
3982 return NULL_TREE;
3984 else if (comp == LT_EXPR || comp == LE_EXPR)
3986 int tst;
3988 /* If VR0 is to the left of VR1, return true. */
3989 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr0->max, vr1->min, strict_overflow_p);
3990 if ((comp == LT_EXPR && tst == -1)
3991 || (comp == LE_EXPR && (tst == -1 || tst == 0)))
3993 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr0)
3994 || overflow_infinity_range_p (vr1))
3995 *strict_overflow_p = true;
3996 return boolean_true_node;
3999 /* If VR0 is to the right of VR1, return false. */
4000 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr0->min, vr1->max, strict_overflow_p);
4001 if ((comp == LT_EXPR && (tst == 0 || tst == 1))
4002 || (comp == LE_EXPR && tst == 1))
4004 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr0)
4005 || overflow_infinity_range_p (vr1))
4006 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4007 return boolean_false_node;
4010 /* Otherwise, we don't know. */
4011 return NULL_TREE;
4014 gcc_unreachable ();
4018 /* Given a value range VR, a value VAL and a comparison code COMP, return
4019 BOOLEAN_TRUE_NODE if VR COMP VAL always returns true for all the
4020 values in VR. Return BOOLEAN_FALSE_NODE if the comparison
4021 always returns false. Return NULL_TREE if it is not always
4022 possible to determine the value of the comparison. Also set
4023 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to indicate whether a range with an overflow
4024 infinity was used in the test. */
4026 static tree
4027 compare_range_with_value (enum tree_code comp, value_range_t *vr, tree val,
4028 bool *strict_overflow_p)
4030 if (vr->type == VR_VARYING || vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
4031 return NULL_TREE;
4033 /* Anti-ranges need to be handled separately. */
4034 if (vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
4036 /* For anti-ranges, the only predicates that we can compute at
4037 compile time are equality and inequality. */
4038 if (comp == GT_EXPR
4039 || comp == GE_EXPR
4040 || comp == LT_EXPR
4041 || comp == LE_EXPR)
4042 return NULL_TREE;
4044 /* ~[VAL_1, VAL_2] OP VAL is known if VAL_1 <= VAL <= VAL_2. */
4045 if (value_inside_range (val, vr->min, vr->max) == 1)
4046 return (comp == NE_EXPR) ? boolean_true_node : boolean_false_node;
4048 return NULL_TREE;
4051 if (!usable_range_p (vr, strict_overflow_p))
4052 return NULL_TREE;
4054 if (comp == EQ_EXPR)
4056 /* EQ_EXPR may only be computed if VR represents exactly
4057 one value. */
4058 if (compare_values_warnv (vr->min, vr->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0)
4060 int cmp = compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p);
4061 if (cmp == 0)
4062 return boolean_true_node;
4063 else if (cmp == -1 || cmp == 1 || cmp == 2)
4064 return boolean_false_node;
4066 else if (compare_values_warnv (val, vr->min, strict_overflow_p) == -1
4067 || compare_values_warnv (vr->max, val, strict_overflow_p) == -1)
4068 return boolean_false_node;
4070 return NULL_TREE;
4072 else if (comp == NE_EXPR)
4074 /* If VAL is not inside VR, then they are always different. */
4075 if (compare_values_warnv (vr->max, val, strict_overflow_p) == -1
4076 || compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p) == 1)
4077 return boolean_true_node;
4079 /* If VR represents exactly one value equal to VAL, then return
4080 false. */
4081 if (compare_values_warnv (vr->min, vr->max, strict_overflow_p) == 0
4082 && compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p) == 0)
4083 return boolean_false_node;
4085 /* Otherwise, they may or may not be different. */
4086 return NULL_TREE;
4088 else if (comp == LT_EXPR || comp == LE_EXPR)
4090 int tst;
4092 /* If VR is to the left of VAL, return true. */
4093 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr->max, val, strict_overflow_p);
4094 if ((comp == LT_EXPR && tst == -1)
4095 || (comp == LE_EXPR && (tst == -1 || tst == 0)))
4097 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr))
4098 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4099 return boolean_true_node;
4102 /* If VR is to the right of VAL, return false. */
4103 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p);
4104 if ((comp == LT_EXPR && (tst == 0 || tst == 1))
4105 || (comp == LE_EXPR && tst == 1))
4107 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr))
4108 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4109 return boolean_false_node;
4112 /* Otherwise, we don't know. */
4113 return NULL_TREE;
4115 else if (comp == GT_EXPR || comp == GE_EXPR)
4117 int tst;
4119 /* If VR is to the right of VAL, return true. */
4120 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr->min, val, strict_overflow_p);
4121 if ((comp == GT_EXPR && tst == 1)
4122 || (comp == GE_EXPR && (tst == 0 || tst == 1)))
4124 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr))
4125 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4126 return boolean_true_node;
4129 /* If VR is to the left of VAL, return false. */
4130 tst = compare_values_warnv (vr->max, val, strict_overflow_p);
4131 if ((comp == GT_EXPR && (tst == -1 || tst == 0))
4132 || (comp == GE_EXPR && tst == -1))
4134 if (overflow_infinity_range_p (vr))
4135 *strict_overflow_p = true;
4136 return boolean_false_node;
4139 /* Otherwise, we don't know. */
4140 return NULL_TREE;
4143 gcc_unreachable ();
4147 /* Debugging dumps. */
4149 void dump_value_range (FILE *, value_range_t *);
4150 void debug_value_range (value_range_t *);
4151 void dump_all_value_ranges (FILE *);
4152 void debug_all_value_ranges (void);
4153 void dump_vr_equiv (FILE *, bitmap);
4154 void debug_vr_equiv (bitmap);
4157 /* Dump value range VR to FILE. */
4159 void
4160 dump_value_range (FILE *file, value_range_t *vr)
4162 if (vr == NULL)
4163 fprintf (file, "[]");
4164 else if (vr->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
4165 fprintf (file, "UNDEFINED");
4166 else if (vr->type == VR_RANGE || vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
4168 tree type = TREE_TYPE (vr->min);
4170 fprintf (file, "%s[", (vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE) ? "~" : "");
4172 if (is_negative_overflow_infinity (vr->min))
4173 fprintf (file, "-INF(OVF)");
4174 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
4175 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
4176 && vrp_val_is_min (vr->min))
4177 fprintf (file, "-INF");
4178 else
4179 print_generic_expr (file, vr->min, 0);
4181 fprintf (file, ", ");
4183 if (is_positive_overflow_infinity (vr->max))
4184 fprintf (file, "+INF(OVF)");
4185 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
4186 && vrp_val_is_max (vr->max))
4187 fprintf (file, "+INF");
4188 else
4189 print_generic_expr (file, vr->max, 0);
4191 fprintf (file, "]");
4193 if (vr->equiv)
4195 bitmap_iterator bi;
4196 unsigned i, c = 0;
4198 fprintf (file, " EQUIVALENCES: { ");
4200 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (vr->equiv, 0, i, bi)
4202 print_generic_expr (file, ssa_name (i), 0);
4203 fprintf (file, " ");
4204 c++;
4207 fprintf (file, "} (%u elements)", c);
4210 else if (vr->type == VR_VARYING)
4211 fprintf (file, "VARYING");
4212 else
4213 fprintf (file, "INVALID RANGE");
4217 /* Dump value range VR to stderr. */
4219 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4220 debug_value_range (value_range_t *vr)
4222 dump_value_range (stderr, vr);
4223 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
4227 /* Dump value ranges of all SSA_NAMEs to FILE. */
4229 void
4230 dump_all_value_ranges (FILE *file)
4232 size_t i;
4234 for (i = 0; i < num_vr_values; i++)
4236 if (vr_value[i])
4238 print_generic_expr (file, ssa_name (i), 0);
4239 fprintf (file, ": ");
4240 dump_value_range (file, vr_value[i]);
4241 fprintf (file, "\n");
4245 fprintf (file, "\n");
4249 /* Dump all value ranges to stderr. */
4251 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4252 debug_all_value_ranges (void)
4254 dump_all_value_ranges (stderr);
4258 /* Given a COND_EXPR COND of the form 'V OP W', and an SSA name V,
4259 create a new SSA name N and return the assertion assignment
4260 'V = ASSERT_EXPR <V, V OP W>'. */
4262 static gimple
4263 build_assert_expr_for (tree cond, tree v)
4265 tree a;
4266 gimple assertion;
4268 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (v) == SSA_NAME
4269 && COMPARISON_CLASS_P (cond));
4271 a = build2 (ASSERT_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (v), v, cond);
4272 assertion = gimple_build_assign (NULL_TREE, a);
4274 /* The new ASSERT_EXPR, creates a new SSA name that replaces the
4275 operand of the ASSERT_EXPR. Create it so the new name and the old one
4276 are registered in the replacement table so that we can fix the SSA web
4277 after adding all the ASSERT_EXPRs. */
4278 create_new_def_for (v, assertion, NULL);
4280 return assertion;
4284 /* Return false if EXPR is a predicate expression involving floating
4285 point values. */
4287 static inline bool
4288 fp_predicate (gimple stmt)
4290 GIMPLE_CHECK (stmt, GIMPLE_COND);
4292 return FLOAT_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (stmt)));
4296 /* If the range of values taken by OP can be inferred after STMT executes,
4297 return the comparison code (COMP_CODE_P) and value (VAL_P) that
4298 describes the inferred range. Return true if a range could be
4299 inferred. */
4301 static bool
4302 infer_value_range (gimple stmt, tree op, enum tree_code *comp_code_p, tree *val_p)
4304 *val_p = NULL_TREE;
4305 *comp_code_p = ERROR_MARK;
4307 /* Do not attempt to infer anything in names that flow through
4308 abnormal edges. */
4309 if (SSA_NAME_OCCURS_IN_ABNORMAL_PHI (op))
4310 return false;
4312 /* Similarly, don't infer anything from statements that may throw
4313 exceptions. */
4314 if (stmt_could_throw_p (stmt))
4315 return false;
4317 /* If STMT is the last statement of a basic block with no
4318 successors, there is no point inferring anything about any of its
4319 operands. We would not be able to find a proper insertion point
4320 for the assertion, anyway. */
4321 if (stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt) && EDGE_COUNT (gimple_bb (stmt)->succs) == 0)
4322 return false;
4324 /* We can only assume that a pointer dereference will yield
4325 non-NULL if -fdelete-null-pointer-checks is enabled. */
4326 if (flag_delete_null_pointer_checks
4327 && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op))
4328 && gimple_code (stmt) != GIMPLE_ASM)
4330 unsigned num_uses, num_loads, num_stores;
4332 count_uses_and_derefs (op, stmt, &num_uses, &num_loads, &num_stores);
4333 if (num_loads + num_stores > 0)
4335 *val_p = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op), 0);
4336 *comp_code_p = NE_EXPR;
4337 return true;
4341 return false;
4345 void dump_asserts_for (FILE *, tree);
4346 void debug_asserts_for (tree);
4347 void dump_all_asserts (FILE *);
4348 void debug_all_asserts (void);
4350 /* Dump all the registered assertions for NAME to FILE. */
4352 void
4353 dump_asserts_for (FILE *file, tree name)
4355 assert_locus_t loc;
4357 fprintf (file, "Assertions to be inserted for ");
4358 print_generic_expr (file, name, 0);
4359 fprintf (file, "\n");
4361 loc = asserts_for[SSA_NAME_VERSION (name)];
4362 while (loc)
4364 fprintf (file, "\t");
4365 print_gimple_stmt (file, gsi_stmt (loc->si), 0, 0);
4366 fprintf (file, "\n\tBB #%d", loc->bb->index);
4367 if (loc->e)
4369 fprintf (file, "\n\tEDGE %d->%d", loc->e->src->index,
4370 loc->e->dest->index);
4371 dump_edge_info (file, loc->e, dump_flags, 0);
4373 fprintf (file, "\n\tPREDICATE: ");
4374 print_generic_expr (file, name, 0);
4375 fprintf (file, " %s ", tree_code_name[(int)loc->comp_code]);
4376 print_generic_expr (file, loc->val, 0);
4377 fprintf (file, "\n\n");
4378 loc = loc->next;
4381 fprintf (file, "\n");
4385 /* Dump all the registered assertions for NAME to stderr. */
4387 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4388 debug_asserts_for (tree name)
4390 dump_asserts_for (stderr, name);
4394 /* Dump all the registered assertions for all the names to FILE. */
4396 void
4397 dump_all_asserts (FILE *file)
4399 unsigned i;
4400 bitmap_iterator bi;
4402 fprintf (file, "\nASSERT_EXPRs to be inserted\n\n");
4403 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (need_assert_for, 0, i, bi)
4404 dump_asserts_for (file, ssa_name (i));
4405 fprintf (file, "\n");
4409 /* Dump all the registered assertions for all the names to stderr. */
4411 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
4412 debug_all_asserts (void)
4414 dump_all_asserts (stderr);
4418 /* If NAME doesn't have an ASSERT_EXPR registered for asserting
4419 'EXPR COMP_CODE VAL' at a location that dominates block BB or
4420 E->DEST, then register this location as a possible insertion point
4421 for ASSERT_EXPR <NAME, EXPR COMP_CODE VAL>.
4423 BB, E and SI provide the exact insertion point for the new
4424 ASSERT_EXPR. If BB is NULL, then the ASSERT_EXPR is to be inserted
4425 on edge E. Otherwise, if E is NULL, the ASSERT_EXPR is inserted on
4426 BB. If SI points to a COND_EXPR or a SWITCH_EXPR statement, then E
4427 must not be NULL. */
4429 static void
4430 register_new_assert_for (tree name, tree expr,
4431 enum tree_code comp_code,
4432 tree val,
4433 basic_block bb,
4434 edge e,
4435 gimple_stmt_iterator si)
4437 assert_locus_t n, loc, last_loc;
4438 basic_block dest_bb;
4440 gcc_checking_assert (bb == NULL || e == NULL);
4442 if (e == NULL)
4443 gcc_checking_assert (gimple_code (gsi_stmt (si)) != GIMPLE_COND
4444 && gimple_code (gsi_stmt (si)) != GIMPLE_SWITCH);
4446 /* Never build an assert comparing against an integer constant with
4447 TREE_OVERFLOW set. This confuses our undefined overflow warning
4448 machinery. */
4449 if (TREE_CODE (val) == INTEGER_CST
4450 && TREE_OVERFLOW (val))
4451 val = build_int_cst_wide (TREE_TYPE (val),
4452 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (val), TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (val));
4454 /* The new assertion A will be inserted at BB or E. We need to
4455 determine if the new location is dominated by a previously
4456 registered location for A. If we are doing an edge insertion,
4457 assume that A will be inserted at E->DEST. Note that this is not
4458 necessarily true.
4460 If E is a critical edge, it will be split. But even if E is
4461 split, the new block will dominate the same set of blocks that
4462 E->DEST dominates.
4464 The reverse, however, is not true, blocks dominated by E->DEST
4465 will not be dominated by the new block created to split E. So,
4466 if the insertion location is on a critical edge, we will not use
4467 the new location to move another assertion previously registered
4468 at a block dominated by E->DEST. */
4469 dest_bb = (bb) ? bb : e->dest;
4471 /* If NAME already has an ASSERT_EXPR registered for COMP_CODE and
4472 VAL at a block dominating DEST_BB, then we don't need to insert a new
4473 one. Similarly, if the same assertion already exists at a block
4474 dominated by DEST_BB and the new location is not on a critical
4475 edge, then update the existing location for the assertion (i.e.,
4476 move the assertion up in the dominance tree).
4478 Note, this is implemented as a simple linked list because there
4479 should not be more than a handful of assertions registered per
4480 name. If this becomes a performance problem, a table hashed by
4481 COMP_CODE and VAL could be implemented. */
4482 loc = asserts_for[SSA_NAME_VERSION (name)];
4483 last_loc = loc;
4484 while (loc)
4486 if (loc->comp_code == comp_code
4487 && (loc->val == val
4488 || operand_equal_p (loc->val, val, 0))
4489 && (loc->expr == expr
4490 || operand_equal_p (loc->expr, expr, 0)))
4492 /* If E is not a critical edge and DEST_BB
4493 dominates the existing location for the assertion, move
4494 the assertion up in the dominance tree by updating its
4495 location information. */
4496 if ((e == NULL || !EDGE_CRITICAL_P (e))
4497 && dominated_by_p (CDI_DOMINATORS, loc->bb, dest_bb))
4499 loc->bb = dest_bb;
4500 loc->e = e;
4501 loc->si = si;
4502 return;
4506 /* Update the last node of the list and move to the next one. */
4507 last_loc = loc;
4508 loc = loc->next;
4511 /* If we didn't find an assertion already registered for
4512 NAME COMP_CODE VAL, add a new one at the end of the list of
4513 assertions associated with NAME. */
4514 n = XNEW (struct assert_locus_d);
4515 n->bb = dest_bb;
4516 n->e = e;
4517 n->si = si;
4518 n->comp_code = comp_code;
4519 n->val = val;
4520 n->expr = expr;
4521 n->next = NULL;
4523 if (last_loc)
4524 last_loc->next = n;
4525 else
4526 asserts_for[SSA_NAME_VERSION (name)] = n;
4528 bitmap_set_bit (need_assert_for, SSA_NAME_VERSION (name));
4531 /* (COND_OP0 COND_CODE COND_OP1) is a predicate which uses NAME.
4532 Extract a suitable test code and value and store them into *CODE_P and
4533 *VAL_P so the predicate is normalized to NAME *CODE_P *VAL_P.
4535 If no extraction was possible, return FALSE, otherwise return TRUE.
4537 If INVERT is true, then we invert the result stored into *CODE_P. */
4539 static bool
4540 extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (tree name, enum tree_code cond_code,
4541 tree cond_op0, tree cond_op1,
4542 bool invert, enum tree_code *code_p,
4543 tree *val_p)
4545 enum tree_code comp_code;
4546 tree val;
4548 /* Otherwise, we have a comparison of the form NAME COMP VAL
4549 or VAL COMP NAME. */
4550 if (name == cond_op1)
4552 /* If the predicate is of the form VAL COMP NAME, flip
4553 COMP around because we need to register NAME as the
4554 first operand in the predicate. */
4555 comp_code = swap_tree_comparison (cond_code);
4556 val = cond_op0;
4558 else
4560 /* The comparison is of the form NAME COMP VAL, so the
4561 comparison code remains unchanged. */
4562 comp_code = cond_code;
4563 val = cond_op1;
4566 /* Invert the comparison code as necessary. */
4567 if (invert)
4568 comp_code = invert_tree_comparison (comp_code, 0);
4570 /* VRP does not handle float types. */
4571 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val)))
4572 return false;
4574 /* Do not register always-false predicates.
4575 FIXME: this works around a limitation in fold() when dealing with
4576 enumerations. Given 'enum { N1, N2 } x;', fold will not
4577 fold 'if (x > N2)' to 'if (0)'. */
4578 if ((comp_code == GT_EXPR || comp_code == LT_EXPR)
4579 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (val)))
4581 tree min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val));
4582 tree max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val));
4584 if (comp_code == GT_EXPR
4585 && (!max
4586 || compare_values (val, max) == 0))
4587 return false;
4589 if (comp_code == LT_EXPR
4590 && (!min
4591 || compare_values (val, min) == 0))
4592 return false;
4594 *code_p = comp_code;
4595 *val_p = val;
4596 return true;
4599 /* Find out smallest RES where RES > VAL && (RES & MASK) == RES, if any
4600 (otherwise return VAL). VAL and MASK must be zero-extended for
4601 precision PREC. If SGNBIT is non-zero, first xor VAL with SGNBIT
4602 (to transform signed values into unsigned) and at the end xor
4603 SGNBIT back. */
4605 static double_int
4606 masked_increment (double_int val, double_int mask, double_int sgnbit,
4607 unsigned int prec)
4609 double_int bit = double_int_one, res;
4610 unsigned int i;
4612 val ^= sgnbit;
4613 for (i = 0; i < prec; i++, bit += bit)
4615 res = mask;
4616 if ((res & bit).is_zero ())
4617 continue;
4618 res = bit - double_int_one;
4619 res = (val + bit).and_not (res);
4620 res &= mask;
4621 if (res.ugt (val))
4622 return res ^ sgnbit;
4624 return val ^ sgnbit;
4627 /* Try to register an edge assertion for SSA name NAME on edge E for
4628 the condition COND contributing to the conditional jump pointed to by BSI.
4629 Invert the condition COND if INVERT is true.
4630 Return true if an assertion for NAME could be registered. */
4632 static bool
4633 register_edge_assert_for_2 (tree name, edge e, gimple_stmt_iterator bsi,
4634 enum tree_code cond_code,
4635 tree cond_op0, tree cond_op1, bool invert)
4637 tree val;
4638 enum tree_code comp_code;
4639 bool retval = false;
4641 if (!extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (name, cond_code,
4642 cond_op0,
4643 cond_op1,
4644 invert, &comp_code, &val))
4645 return false;
4647 /* Only register an ASSERT_EXPR if NAME was found in the sub-graph
4648 reachable from E. */
4649 if (live_on_edge (e, name)
4650 && !has_single_use (name))
4652 register_new_assert_for (name, name, comp_code, val, NULL, e, bsi);
4653 retval = true;
4656 /* In the case of NAME <= CST and NAME being defined as
4657 NAME = (unsigned) NAME2 + CST2 we can assert NAME2 >= -CST2
4658 and NAME2 <= CST - CST2. We can do the same for NAME > CST.
4659 This catches range and anti-range tests. */
4660 if ((comp_code == LE_EXPR
4661 || comp_code == GT_EXPR)
4662 && TREE_CODE (val) == INTEGER_CST
4663 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val)))
4665 gimple def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name);
4666 tree cst2 = NULL_TREE, name2 = NULL_TREE, name3 = NULL_TREE;
4668 /* Extract CST2 from the (optional) addition. */
4669 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
4670 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) == PLUS_EXPR)
4672 name2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
4673 cst2 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
4674 if (TREE_CODE (name2) == SSA_NAME
4675 && TREE_CODE (cst2) == INTEGER_CST)
4676 def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name2);
4679 /* Extract NAME2 from the (optional) sign-changing cast. */
4680 if (gimple_assign_cast_p (def_stmt))
4682 if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt))
4683 && ! TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt)))
4684 && (TYPE_PRECISION (gimple_expr_type (def_stmt))
4685 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt)))))
4686 name3 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
4689 /* If name3 is used later, create an ASSERT_EXPR for it. */
4690 if (name3 != NULL_TREE
4691 && TREE_CODE (name3) == SSA_NAME
4692 && (cst2 == NULL_TREE
4693 || TREE_CODE (cst2) == INTEGER_CST)
4694 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name3))
4695 && live_on_edge (e, name3)
4696 && !has_single_use (name3))
4698 tree tmp;
4700 /* Build an expression for the range test. */
4701 tmp = build1 (NOP_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name), name3);
4702 if (cst2 != NULL_TREE)
4703 tmp = build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name), tmp, cst2);
4705 if (dump_file)
4707 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
4708 print_generic_expr (dump_file, name3, 0);
4709 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
4710 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
4711 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
4714 register_new_assert_for (name3, tmp, comp_code, val, NULL, e, bsi);
4716 retval = true;
4719 /* If name2 is used later, create an ASSERT_EXPR for it. */
4720 if (name2 != NULL_TREE
4721 && TREE_CODE (name2) == SSA_NAME
4722 && TREE_CODE (cst2) == INTEGER_CST
4723 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2))
4724 && live_on_edge (e, name2)
4725 && !has_single_use (name2))
4727 tree tmp;
4729 /* Build an expression for the range test. */
4730 tmp = name2;
4731 if (TREE_TYPE (name) != TREE_TYPE (name2))
4732 tmp = build1 (NOP_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name), tmp);
4733 if (cst2 != NULL_TREE)
4734 tmp = build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name), tmp, cst2);
4736 if (dump_file)
4738 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
4739 print_generic_expr (dump_file, name2, 0);
4740 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
4741 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
4742 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
4745 register_new_assert_for (name2, tmp, comp_code, val, NULL, e, bsi);
4747 retval = true;
4751 /* In the case of post-in/decrement tests like if (i++) ... and uses
4752 of the in/decremented value on the edge the extra name we want to
4753 assert for is not on the def chain of the name compared. Instead
4754 it is in the set of use stmts. */
4755 if ((comp_code == NE_EXPR
4756 || comp_code == EQ_EXPR)
4757 && TREE_CODE (val) == INTEGER_CST)
4759 imm_use_iterator ui;
4760 gimple use_stmt;
4761 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_STMT (use_stmt, ui, name)
4763 /* Cut off to use-stmts that are in the predecessor. */
4764 if (gimple_bb (use_stmt) != e->src)
4765 continue;
4767 if (!is_gimple_assign (use_stmt))
4768 continue;
4770 enum tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (use_stmt);
4771 if (code != PLUS_EXPR
4772 && code != MINUS_EXPR)
4773 continue;
4775 tree cst = gimple_assign_rhs2 (use_stmt);
4776 if (TREE_CODE (cst) != INTEGER_CST)
4777 continue;
4779 tree name2 = gimple_assign_lhs (use_stmt);
4780 if (live_on_edge (e, name2))
4782 cst = int_const_binop (code, val, cst);
4783 register_new_assert_for (name2, name2, comp_code, cst,
4784 NULL, e, bsi);
4785 retval = true;
4790 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (comp_code) == tcc_comparison
4791 && TREE_CODE (val) == INTEGER_CST)
4793 gimple def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name);
4794 tree name2 = NULL_TREE, names[2], cst2 = NULL_TREE;
4795 tree val2 = NULL_TREE;
4796 double_int mask = double_int_zero;
4797 unsigned int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (val));
4798 unsigned int nprec = prec;
4799 enum tree_code rhs_code = ERROR_MARK;
4801 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt))
4802 rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt);
4804 /* Add asserts for NAME cmp CST and NAME being defined
4805 as NAME = (int) NAME2. */
4806 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val))
4807 && (comp_code == LE_EXPR || comp_code == LT_EXPR
4808 || comp_code == GT_EXPR || comp_code == GE_EXPR)
4809 && gimple_assign_cast_p (def_stmt))
4811 name2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
4812 if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (rhs_code)
4813 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2))
4814 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (name2))
4815 && prec == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2))
4816 && (comp_code == LE_EXPR || comp_code == GT_EXPR
4817 || !tree_int_cst_equal (val,
4818 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val))))
4819 && live_on_edge (e, name2)
4820 && !has_single_use (name2))
4822 tree tmp, cst;
4823 enum tree_code new_comp_code = comp_code;
4825 cst = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (name2),
4826 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val)));
4827 /* Build an expression for the range test. */
4828 tmp = build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name2), name2, cst);
4829 cst = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name2), cst,
4830 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (name2), val));
4831 if (comp_code == LT_EXPR || comp_code == GE_EXPR)
4833 new_comp_code = comp_code == LT_EXPR ? LE_EXPR : GT_EXPR;
4834 cst = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (name2), cst,
4835 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (name2), 1));
4838 if (dump_file)
4840 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
4841 print_generic_expr (dump_file, name2, 0);
4842 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
4843 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
4844 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
4847 register_new_assert_for (name2, tmp, new_comp_code, cst, NULL,
4848 e, bsi);
4850 retval = true;
4854 /* Add asserts for NAME cmp CST and NAME being defined as
4855 NAME = NAME2 >> CST2.
4857 Extract CST2 from the right shift. */
4858 if (rhs_code == RSHIFT_EXPR)
4860 name2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
4861 cst2 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
4862 if (TREE_CODE (name2) == SSA_NAME
4863 && host_integerp (cst2, 1)
4864 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2))
4865 && IN_RANGE (tree_low_cst (cst2, 1), 1, prec - 1)
4866 && prec <= HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
4867 && prec == GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (val)))
4868 && live_on_edge (e, name2)
4869 && !has_single_use (name2))
4871 mask = double_int::mask (tree_low_cst (cst2, 1));
4872 val2 = fold_binary (LSHIFT_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (val), val, cst2);
4875 if (val2 != NULL_TREE
4876 && TREE_CODE (val2) == INTEGER_CST
4877 && simple_cst_equal (fold_build2 (RSHIFT_EXPR,
4878 TREE_TYPE (val),
4879 val2, cst2), val))
4881 enum tree_code new_comp_code = comp_code;
4882 tree tmp, new_val;
4884 tmp = name2;
4885 if (comp_code == EQ_EXPR || comp_code == NE_EXPR)
4887 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val)))
4889 tree type = build_nonstandard_integer_type (prec, 1);
4890 tmp = build1 (NOP_EXPR, type, name2);
4891 val2 = fold_convert (type, val2);
4893 tmp = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tmp), tmp, val2);
4894 new_val = double_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (tmp), mask);
4895 new_comp_code = comp_code == EQ_EXPR ? LE_EXPR : GT_EXPR;
4897 else if (comp_code == LT_EXPR || comp_code == GE_EXPR)
4899 double_int minval
4900 = double_int::min_value (prec, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val)));
4901 new_val = val2;
4902 if (minval == tree_to_double_int (new_val))
4903 new_val = NULL_TREE;
4905 else
4907 double_int maxval
4908 = double_int::max_value (prec, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val)));
4909 mask |= tree_to_double_int (val2);
4910 if (mask == maxval)
4911 new_val = NULL_TREE;
4912 else
4913 new_val = double_int_to_tree (TREE_TYPE (val2), mask);
4916 if (new_val)
4918 if (dump_file)
4920 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
4921 print_generic_expr (dump_file, name2, 0);
4922 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
4923 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
4924 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
4927 register_new_assert_for (name2, tmp, new_comp_code, new_val,
4928 NULL, e, bsi);
4929 retval = true;
4933 /* Add asserts for NAME cmp CST and NAME being defined as
4934 NAME = NAME2 & CST2.
4936 Extract CST2 from the and.
4938 Also handle
4939 NAME = (unsigned) NAME2;
4940 casts where NAME's type is unsigned and has smaller precision
4941 than NAME2's type as if it was NAME = NAME2 & MASK. */
4942 names[0] = NULL_TREE;
4943 names[1] = NULL_TREE;
4944 cst2 = NULL_TREE;
4945 if (rhs_code == BIT_AND_EXPR
4946 || (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (rhs_code)
4947 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (val)) == INTEGER_TYPE
4948 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val))
4949 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt)))
4950 > prec
4951 && !retval))
4953 name2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
4954 if (rhs_code == BIT_AND_EXPR)
4955 cst2 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
4956 else
4958 cst2 = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (val));
4959 nprec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2));
4961 if (TREE_CODE (name2) == SSA_NAME
4962 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (name2))
4963 && TREE_CODE (cst2) == INTEGER_CST
4964 && !integer_zerop (cst2)
4965 && nprec <= HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
4966 && (nprec > 1
4967 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val))))
4969 gimple def_stmt2 = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name2);
4970 if (gimple_assign_cast_p (def_stmt2))
4972 names[1] = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt2);
4973 if (!CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt2))
4974 || !INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (names[1]))
4975 || (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name2))
4976 != TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (names[1])))
4977 || !live_on_edge (e, names[1])
4978 || has_single_use (names[1]))
4979 names[1] = NULL_TREE;
4981 if (live_on_edge (e, name2)
4982 && !has_single_use (name2))
4983 names[0] = name2;
4986 if (names[0] || names[1])
4988 double_int minv, maxv = double_int_zero, valv, cst2v;
4989 double_int tem, sgnbit;
4990 bool valid_p = false, valn = false, cst2n = false;
4991 enum tree_code ccode = comp_code;
4993 valv = tree_to_double_int (val).zext (nprec);
4994 cst2v = tree_to_double_int (cst2).zext (nprec);
4995 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (val)))
4997 valn = valv.sext (nprec).is_negative ();
4998 cst2n = cst2v.sext (nprec).is_negative ();
5000 /* If CST2 doesn't have most significant bit set,
5001 but VAL is negative, we have comparison like
5002 if ((x & 0x123) > -4) (always true). Just give up. */
5003 if (!cst2n && valn)
5004 ccode = ERROR_MARK;
5005 if (cst2n)
5006 sgnbit = double_int_one.llshift (nprec - 1, nprec).zext (nprec);
5007 else
5008 sgnbit = double_int_zero;
5009 minv = valv & cst2v;
5010 switch (ccode)
5012 case EQ_EXPR:
5013 /* Minimum unsigned value for equality is VAL & CST2
5014 (should be equal to VAL, otherwise we probably should
5015 have folded the comparison into false) and
5016 maximum unsigned value is VAL | ~CST2. */
5017 maxv = valv | ~cst2v;
5018 maxv = maxv.zext (nprec);
5019 valid_p = true;
5020 break;
5021 case NE_EXPR:
5022 tem = valv | ~cst2v;
5023 tem = tem.zext (nprec);
5024 /* If VAL is 0, handle (X & CST2) != 0 as (X & CST2) > 0U. */
5025 if (valv.is_zero ())
5027 cst2n = false;
5028 sgnbit = double_int_zero;
5029 goto gt_expr;
5031 /* If (VAL | ~CST2) is all ones, handle it as
5032 (X & CST2) < VAL. */
5033 if (tem == double_int::mask (nprec))
5035 cst2n = false;
5036 valn = false;
5037 sgnbit = double_int_zero;
5038 goto lt_expr;
5040 if (!cst2n
5041 && cst2v.sext (nprec).is_negative ())
5042 sgnbit
5043 = double_int_one.llshift (nprec - 1, nprec).zext (nprec);
5044 if (!sgnbit.is_zero ())
5046 if (valv == sgnbit)
5048 cst2n = true;
5049 valn = true;
5050 goto gt_expr;
5052 if (tem == double_int::mask (nprec - 1))
5054 cst2n = true;
5055 goto lt_expr;
5057 if (!cst2n)
5058 sgnbit = double_int_zero;
5060 break;
5061 case GE_EXPR:
5062 /* Minimum unsigned value for >= if (VAL & CST2) == VAL
5063 is VAL and maximum unsigned value is ~0. For signed
5064 comparison, if CST2 doesn't have most significant bit
5065 set, handle it similarly. If CST2 has MSB set,
5066 the minimum is the same, and maximum is ~0U/2. */
5067 if (minv != valv)
5069 /* If (VAL & CST2) != VAL, X & CST2 can't be equal to
5070 VAL. */
5071 minv = masked_increment (valv, cst2v, sgnbit, nprec);
5072 if (minv == valv)
5073 break;
5075 maxv = double_int::mask (nprec - (cst2n ? 1 : 0));
5076 valid_p = true;
5077 break;
5078 case GT_EXPR:
5079 gt_expr:
5080 /* Find out smallest MINV where MINV > VAL
5081 && (MINV & CST2) == MINV, if any. If VAL is signed and
5082 CST2 has MSB set, compute it biased by 1 << (nprec - 1). */
5083 minv = masked_increment (valv, cst2v, sgnbit, nprec);
5084 if (minv == valv)
5085 break;
5086 maxv = double_int::mask (nprec - (cst2n ? 1 : 0));
5087 valid_p = true;
5088 break;
5089 case LE_EXPR:
5090 /* Minimum unsigned value for <= is 0 and maximum
5091 unsigned value is VAL | ~CST2 if (VAL & CST2) == VAL.
5092 Otherwise, find smallest VAL2 where VAL2 > VAL
5093 && (VAL2 & CST2) == VAL2 and use (VAL2 - 1) | ~CST2
5094 as maximum.
5095 For signed comparison, if CST2 doesn't have most
5096 significant bit set, handle it similarly. If CST2 has
5097 MSB set, the maximum is the same and minimum is INT_MIN. */
5098 if (minv == valv)
5099 maxv = valv;
5100 else
5102 maxv = masked_increment (valv, cst2v, sgnbit, nprec);
5103 if (maxv == valv)
5104 break;
5105 maxv -= double_int_one;
5107 maxv |= ~cst2v;
5108 maxv = maxv.zext (nprec);
5109 minv = sgnbit;
5110 valid_p = true;
5111 break;
5112 case LT_EXPR:
5113 lt_expr:
5114 /* Minimum unsigned value for < is 0 and maximum
5115 unsigned value is (VAL-1) | ~CST2 if (VAL & CST2) == VAL.
5116 Otherwise, find smallest VAL2 where VAL2 > VAL
5117 && (VAL2 & CST2) == VAL2 and use (VAL2 - 1) | ~CST2
5118 as maximum.
5119 For signed comparison, if CST2 doesn't have most
5120 significant bit set, handle it similarly. If CST2 has
5121 MSB set, the maximum is the same and minimum is INT_MIN. */
5122 if (minv == valv)
5124 if (valv == sgnbit)
5125 break;
5126 maxv = valv;
5128 else
5130 maxv = masked_increment (valv, cst2v, sgnbit, nprec);
5131 if (maxv == valv)
5132 break;
5134 maxv -= double_int_one;
5135 maxv |= ~cst2v;
5136 maxv = maxv.zext (nprec);
5137 minv = sgnbit;
5138 valid_p = true;
5139 break;
5140 default:
5141 break;
5143 if (valid_p
5144 && (maxv - minv).zext (nprec) != double_int::mask (nprec))
5146 tree tmp, new_val, type;
5147 int i;
5149 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
5150 if (names[i])
5152 double_int maxv2 = maxv;
5153 tmp = names[i];
5154 type = TREE_TYPE (names[i]);
5155 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
5157 type = build_nonstandard_integer_type (nprec, 1);
5158 tmp = build1 (NOP_EXPR, type, names[i]);
5160 if (!minv.is_zero ())
5162 tmp = build2 (PLUS_EXPR, type, tmp,
5163 double_int_to_tree (type, -minv));
5164 maxv2 = maxv - minv;
5166 new_val = double_int_to_tree (type, maxv2);
5168 if (dump_file)
5170 fprintf (dump_file, "Adding assert for ");
5171 print_generic_expr (dump_file, names[i], 0);
5172 fprintf (dump_file, " from ");
5173 print_generic_expr (dump_file, tmp, 0);
5174 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
5177 register_new_assert_for (names[i], tmp, LE_EXPR,
5178 new_val, NULL, e, bsi);
5179 retval = true;
5185 return retval;
5188 /* OP is an operand of a truth value expression which is known to have
5189 a particular value. Register any asserts for OP and for any
5190 operands in OP's defining statement.
5192 If CODE is EQ_EXPR, then we want to register OP is zero (false),
5193 if CODE is NE_EXPR, then we want to register OP is nonzero (true). */
5195 static bool
5196 register_edge_assert_for_1 (tree op, enum tree_code code,
5197 edge e, gimple_stmt_iterator bsi)
5199 bool retval = false;
5200 gimple op_def;
5201 tree val;
5202 enum tree_code rhs_code;
5204 /* We only care about SSA_NAMEs. */
5205 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
5206 return false;
5208 /* We know that OP will have a zero or nonzero value. If OP is used
5209 more than once go ahead and register an assert for OP.
5211 The FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH support is not helpful in this situation as
5212 it will always be set for OP (because OP is used in a COND_EXPR in
5213 the subgraph). */
5214 if (!has_single_use (op))
5216 val = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op), 0);
5217 register_new_assert_for (op, op, code, val, NULL, e, bsi);
5218 retval = true;
5221 /* Now look at how OP is set. If it's set from a comparison,
5222 a truth operation or some bit operations, then we may be able
5223 to register information about the operands of that assignment. */
5224 op_def = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (op);
5225 if (gimple_code (op_def) != GIMPLE_ASSIGN)
5226 return retval;
5228 rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def);
5230 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (rhs_code) == tcc_comparison)
5232 bool invert = (code == EQ_EXPR ? true : false);
5233 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def);
5234 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (op_def);
5236 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
5237 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_2 (op0, e, bsi, rhs_code, op0, op1,
5238 invert);
5239 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
5240 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_2 (op1, e, bsi, rhs_code, op0, op1,
5241 invert);
5243 else if ((code == NE_EXPR
5244 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
5245 || (code == EQ_EXPR
5246 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def) == BIT_IOR_EXPR))
5248 /* Recurse on each operand. */
5249 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def);
5250 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (op_def);
5251 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME
5252 && has_single_use (op0))
5253 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op0, code, e, bsi);
5254 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME
5255 && has_single_use (op1))
5256 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op1, code, e, bsi);
5258 else if (gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def) == BIT_NOT_EXPR
5259 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (op_def))) == 1)
5261 /* Recurse, flipping CODE. */
5262 code = invert_tree_comparison (code, false);
5263 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_1 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def),
5264 code, e, bsi);
5266 else if (gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def) == SSA_NAME)
5268 /* Recurse through the copy. */
5269 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_1 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def),
5270 code, e, bsi);
5272 else if (CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (op_def)))
5274 /* Recurse through the type conversion, unless it is a narrowing
5275 conversion or conversion from non-integral type. */
5276 tree rhs = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op_def);
5277 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs))
5278 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (rhs))
5279 <= TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (op))))
5280 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_1 (rhs, code, e, bsi);
5283 return retval;
5286 /* Try to register an edge assertion for SSA name NAME on edge E for
5287 the condition COND contributing to the conditional jump pointed to by SI.
5288 Return true if an assertion for NAME could be registered. */
5290 static bool
5291 register_edge_assert_for (tree name, edge e, gimple_stmt_iterator si,
5292 enum tree_code cond_code, tree cond_op0,
5293 tree cond_op1)
5295 tree val;
5296 enum tree_code comp_code;
5297 bool retval = false;
5298 bool is_else_edge = (e->flags & EDGE_FALSE_VALUE) != 0;
5300 /* Do not attempt to infer anything in names that flow through
5301 abnormal edges. */
5302 if (SSA_NAME_OCCURS_IN_ABNORMAL_PHI (name))
5303 return false;
5305 if (!extract_code_and_val_from_cond_with_ops (name, cond_code,
5306 cond_op0, cond_op1,
5307 is_else_edge,
5308 &comp_code, &val))
5309 return false;
5311 /* Register ASSERT_EXPRs for name. */
5312 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_2 (name, e, si, cond_code, cond_op0,
5313 cond_op1, is_else_edge);
5316 /* If COND is effectively an equality test of an SSA_NAME against
5317 the value zero or one, then we may be able to assert values
5318 for SSA_NAMEs which flow into COND. */
5320 /* In the case of NAME == 1 or NAME != 0, for BIT_AND_EXPR defining
5321 statement of NAME we can assert both operands of the BIT_AND_EXPR
5322 have nonzero value. */
5323 if (((comp_code == EQ_EXPR && integer_onep (val))
5324 || (comp_code == NE_EXPR && integer_zerop (val))))
5326 gimple def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name);
5328 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
5329 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
5331 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5332 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
5333 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op0, NE_EXPR, e, si);
5334 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op1, NE_EXPR, e, si);
5338 /* In the case of NAME == 0 or NAME != 1, for BIT_IOR_EXPR defining
5339 statement of NAME we can assert both operands of the BIT_IOR_EXPR
5340 have zero value. */
5341 if (((comp_code == EQ_EXPR && integer_zerop (val))
5342 || (comp_code == NE_EXPR && integer_onep (val))))
5344 gimple def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (name);
5346 /* For BIT_IOR_EXPR only if NAME == 0 both operands have
5347 necessarily zero value, or if type-precision is one. */
5348 if (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
5349 && (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
5350 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (name)) == 1
5351 || comp_code == EQ_EXPR)))
5353 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5354 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
5355 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op0, EQ_EXPR, e, si);
5356 retval |= register_edge_assert_for_1 (op1, EQ_EXPR, e, si);
5360 return retval;
5364 /* Determine whether the outgoing edges of BB should receive an
5365 ASSERT_EXPR for each of the operands of BB's LAST statement.
5366 The last statement of BB must be a COND_EXPR.
5368 If any of the sub-graphs rooted at BB have an interesting use of
5369 the predicate operands, an assert location node is added to the
5370 list of assertions for the corresponding operands. */
5372 static bool
5373 find_conditional_asserts (basic_block bb, gimple last)
5375 bool need_assert;
5376 gimple_stmt_iterator bsi;
5377 tree op;
5378 edge_iterator ei;
5379 edge e;
5380 ssa_op_iter iter;
5382 need_assert = false;
5383 bsi = gsi_for_stmt (last);
5385 /* Look for uses of the operands in each of the sub-graphs
5386 rooted at BB. We need to check each of the outgoing edges
5387 separately, so that we know what kind of ASSERT_EXPR to
5388 insert. */
5389 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
5391 if (e->dest == bb)
5392 continue;
5394 /* Register the necessary assertions for each operand in the
5395 conditional predicate. */
5396 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op, last, iter, SSA_OP_USE)
5398 need_assert |= register_edge_assert_for (op, e, bsi,
5399 gimple_cond_code (last),
5400 gimple_cond_lhs (last),
5401 gimple_cond_rhs (last));
5405 return need_assert;
5408 struct case_info
5410 tree expr;
5411 basic_block bb;
5414 /* Compare two case labels sorting first by the destination bb index
5415 and then by the case value. */
5417 static int
5418 compare_case_labels (const void *p1, const void *p2)
5420 const struct case_info *ci1 = (const struct case_info *) p1;
5421 const struct case_info *ci2 = (const struct case_info *) p2;
5422 int idx1 = ci1->bb->index;
5423 int idx2 = ci2->bb->index;
5425 if (idx1 < idx2)
5426 return -1;
5427 else if (idx1 == idx2)
5429 /* Make sure the default label is first in a group. */
5430 if (!CASE_LOW (ci1->expr))
5431 return -1;
5432 else if (!CASE_LOW (ci2->expr))
5433 return 1;
5434 else
5435 return tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (ci1->expr),
5436 CASE_LOW (ci2->expr));
5438 else
5439 return 1;
5442 /* Determine whether the outgoing edges of BB should receive an
5443 ASSERT_EXPR for each of the operands of BB's LAST statement.
5444 The last statement of BB must be a SWITCH_EXPR.
5446 If any of the sub-graphs rooted at BB have an interesting use of
5447 the predicate operands, an assert location node is added to the
5448 list of assertions for the corresponding operands. */
5450 static bool
5451 find_switch_asserts (basic_block bb, gimple last)
5453 bool need_assert;
5454 gimple_stmt_iterator bsi;
5455 tree op;
5456 edge e;
5457 struct case_info *ci;
5458 size_t n = gimple_switch_num_labels (last);
5459 #if GCC_VERSION >= 4000
5460 unsigned int idx;
5461 #else
5462 /* Work around GCC 3.4 bug (PR 37086). */
5463 volatile unsigned int idx;
5464 #endif
5466 need_assert = false;
5467 bsi = gsi_for_stmt (last);
5468 op = gimple_switch_index (last);
5469 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
5470 return false;
5472 /* Build a vector of case labels sorted by destination label. */
5473 ci = XNEWVEC (struct case_info, n);
5474 for (idx = 0; idx < n; ++idx)
5476 ci[idx].expr = gimple_switch_label (last, idx);
5477 ci[idx].bb = label_to_block (CASE_LABEL (ci[idx].expr));
5479 qsort (ci, n, sizeof (struct case_info), compare_case_labels);
5481 for (idx = 0; idx < n; ++idx)
5483 tree min, max;
5484 tree cl = ci[idx].expr;
5485 basic_block cbb = ci[idx].bb;
5487 min = CASE_LOW (cl);
5488 max = CASE_HIGH (cl);
5490 /* If there are multiple case labels with the same destination
5491 we need to combine them to a single value range for the edge. */
5492 if (idx + 1 < n && cbb == ci[idx + 1].bb)
5494 /* Skip labels until the last of the group. */
5495 do {
5496 ++idx;
5497 } while (idx < n && cbb == ci[idx].bb);
5498 --idx;
5500 /* Pick up the maximum of the case label range. */
5501 if (CASE_HIGH (ci[idx].expr))
5502 max = CASE_HIGH (ci[idx].expr);
5503 else
5504 max = CASE_LOW (ci[idx].expr);
5507 /* Nothing to do if the range includes the default label until we
5508 can register anti-ranges. */
5509 if (min == NULL_TREE)
5510 continue;
5512 /* Find the edge to register the assert expr on. */
5513 e = find_edge (bb, cbb);
5515 /* Register the necessary assertions for the operand in the
5516 SWITCH_EXPR. */
5517 need_assert |= register_edge_assert_for (op, e, bsi,
5518 max ? GE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR,
5520 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op),
5521 min));
5522 if (max)
5524 need_assert |= register_edge_assert_for (op, e, bsi, LE_EXPR,
5526 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op),
5527 max));
5531 XDELETEVEC (ci);
5532 return need_assert;
5536 /* Traverse all the statements in block BB looking for statements that
5537 may generate useful assertions for the SSA names in their operand.
5538 If a statement produces a useful assertion A for name N_i, then the
5539 list of assertions already generated for N_i is scanned to
5540 determine if A is actually needed.
5542 If N_i already had the assertion A at a location dominating the
5543 current location, then nothing needs to be done. Otherwise, the
5544 new location for A is recorded instead.
5546 1- For every statement S in BB, all the variables used by S are
5547 added to bitmap FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH.
5549 2- If statement S uses an operand N in a way that exposes a known
5550 value range for N, then if N was not already generated by an
5551 ASSERT_EXPR, create a new assert location for N. For instance,
5552 if N is a pointer and the statement dereferences it, we can
5553 assume that N is not NULL.
5555 3- COND_EXPRs are a special case of #2. We can derive range
5556 information from the predicate but need to insert different
5557 ASSERT_EXPRs for each of the sub-graphs rooted at the
5558 conditional block. If the last statement of BB is a conditional
5559 expression of the form 'X op Y', then
5561 a) Remove X and Y from the set FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH.
5563 b) If the conditional is the only entry point to the sub-graph
5564 corresponding to the THEN_CLAUSE, recurse into it. On
5565 return, if X and/or Y are marked in FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH, then
5566 an ASSERT_EXPR is added for the corresponding variable.
5568 c) Repeat step (b) on the ELSE_CLAUSE.
5570 d) Mark X and Y in FOUND_IN_SUBGRAPH.
5572 For instance,
5574 if (a == 9)
5575 b = a;
5576 else
5577 b = c + 1;
5579 In this case, an assertion on the THEN clause is useful to
5580 determine that 'a' is always 9 on that edge. However, an assertion
5581 on the ELSE clause would be unnecessary.
5583 4- If BB does not end in a conditional expression, then we recurse
5584 into BB's dominator children.
5586 At the end of the recursive traversal, every SSA name will have a
5587 list of locations where ASSERT_EXPRs should be added. When a new
5588 location for name N is found, it is registered by calling
5589 register_new_assert_for. That function keeps track of all the
5590 registered assertions to prevent adding unnecessary assertions.
5591 For instance, if a pointer P_4 is dereferenced more than once in a
5592 dominator tree, only the location dominating all the dereference of
5593 P_4 will receive an ASSERT_EXPR.
5595 If this function returns true, then it means that there are names
5596 for which we need to generate ASSERT_EXPRs. Those assertions are
5597 inserted by process_assert_insertions. */
5599 static bool
5600 find_assert_locations_1 (basic_block bb, sbitmap live)
5602 gimple_stmt_iterator si;
5603 gimple last;
5604 bool need_assert;
5606 need_assert = false;
5607 last = last_stmt (bb);
5609 /* If BB's last statement is a conditional statement involving integer
5610 operands, determine if we need to add ASSERT_EXPRs. */
5611 if (last
5612 && gimple_code (last) == GIMPLE_COND
5613 && !fp_predicate (last)
5614 && !ZERO_SSA_OPERANDS (last, SSA_OP_USE))
5615 need_assert |= find_conditional_asserts (bb, last);
5617 /* If BB's last statement is a switch statement involving integer
5618 operands, determine if we need to add ASSERT_EXPRs. */
5619 if (last
5620 && gimple_code (last) == GIMPLE_SWITCH
5621 && !ZERO_SSA_OPERANDS (last, SSA_OP_USE))
5622 need_assert |= find_switch_asserts (bb, last);
5624 /* Traverse all the statements in BB marking used names and looking
5625 for statements that may infer assertions for their used operands. */
5626 for (si = gsi_last_bb (bb); !gsi_end_p (si); gsi_prev (&si))
5628 gimple stmt;
5629 tree op;
5630 ssa_op_iter i;
5632 stmt = gsi_stmt (si);
5634 if (is_gimple_debug (stmt))
5635 continue;
5637 /* See if we can derive an assertion for any of STMT's operands. */
5638 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op, stmt, i, SSA_OP_USE)
5640 tree value;
5641 enum tree_code comp_code;
5643 /* If op is not live beyond this stmt, do not bother to insert
5644 asserts for it. */
5645 if (!bitmap_bit_p (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (op)))
5646 continue;
5648 /* If OP is used in such a way that we can infer a value
5649 range for it, and we don't find a previous assertion for
5650 it, create a new assertion location node for OP. */
5651 if (infer_value_range (stmt, op, &comp_code, &value))
5653 /* If we are able to infer a nonzero value range for OP,
5654 then walk backwards through the use-def chain to see if OP
5655 was set via a typecast.
5657 If so, then we can also infer a nonzero value range
5658 for the operand of the NOP_EXPR. */
5659 if (comp_code == NE_EXPR && integer_zerop (value))
5661 tree t = op;
5662 gimple def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t);
5664 while (is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
5665 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) == NOP_EXPR
5666 && TREE_CODE
5667 (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt)) == SSA_NAME
5668 && POINTER_TYPE_P
5669 (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt))))
5671 t = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
5672 def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t);
5674 /* Note we want to register the assert for the
5675 operand of the NOP_EXPR after SI, not after the
5676 conversion. */
5677 if (! has_single_use (t))
5679 register_new_assert_for (t, t, comp_code, value,
5680 bb, NULL, si);
5681 need_assert = true;
5686 register_new_assert_for (op, op, comp_code, value, bb, NULL, si);
5687 need_assert = true;
5691 /* Update live. */
5692 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op, stmt, i, SSA_OP_USE)
5693 bitmap_set_bit (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (op));
5694 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (op, stmt, i, SSA_OP_DEF)
5695 bitmap_clear_bit (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (op));
5698 /* Traverse all PHI nodes in BB, updating live. */
5699 for (si = gsi_start_phis (bb); !gsi_end_p(si); gsi_next (&si))
5701 use_operand_p arg_p;
5702 ssa_op_iter i;
5703 gimple phi = gsi_stmt (si);
5704 tree res = gimple_phi_result (phi);
5706 if (virtual_operand_p (res))
5707 continue;
5709 FOR_EACH_PHI_ARG (arg_p, phi, i, SSA_OP_USE)
5711 tree arg = USE_FROM_PTR (arg_p);
5712 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
5713 bitmap_set_bit (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (arg));
5716 bitmap_clear_bit (live, SSA_NAME_VERSION (res));
5719 return need_assert;
5722 /* Do an RPO walk over the function computing SSA name liveness
5723 on-the-fly and deciding on assert expressions to insert.
5724 Returns true if there are assert expressions to be inserted. */
5726 static bool
5727 find_assert_locations (void)
5729 int *rpo = XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block);
5730 int *bb_rpo = XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block);
5731 int *last_rpo = XCNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block);
5732 int rpo_cnt, i;
5733 bool need_asserts;
5735 live = XCNEWVEC (sbitmap, last_basic_block);
5736 rpo_cnt = pre_and_rev_post_order_compute (NULL, rpo, false);
5737 for (i = 0; i < rpo_cnt; ++i)
5738 bb_rpo[rpo[i]] = i;
5740 need_asserts = false;
5741 for (i = rpo_cnt - 1; i >= 0; --i)
5743 basic_block bb = BASIC_BLOCK (rpo[i]);
5744 edge e;
5745 edge_iterator ei;
5747 if (!live[rpo[i]])
5749 live[rpo[i]] = sbitmap_alloc (num_ssa_names);
5750 bitmap_clear (live[rpo[i]]);
5753 /* Process BB and update the live information with uses in
5754 this block. */
5755 need_asserts |= find_assert_locations_1 (bb, live[rpo[i]]);
5757 /* Merge liveness into the predecessor blocks and free it. */
5758 if (!bitmap_empty_p (live[rpo[i]]))
5760 int pred_rpo = i;
5761 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
5763 int pred = e->src->index;
5764 if ((e->flags & EDGE_DFS_BACK) || pred == ENTRY_BLOCK)
5765 continue;
5767 if (!live[pred])
5769 live[pred] = sbitmap_alloc (num_ssa_names);
5770 bitmap_clear (live[pred]);
5772 bitmap_ior (live[pred], live[pred], live[rpo[i]]);
5774 if (bb_rpo[pred] < pred_rpo)
5775 pred_rpo = bb_rpo[pred];
5778 /* Record the RPO number of the last visited block that needs
5779 live information from this block. */
5780 last_rpo[rpo[i]] = pred_rpo;
5782 else
5784 sbitmap_free (live[rpo[i]]);
5785 live[rpo[i]] = NULL;
5788 /* We can free all successors live bitmaps if all their
5789 predecessors have been visited already. */
5790 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
5791 if (last_rpo[e->dest->index] == i
5792 && live[e->dest->index])
5794 sbitmap_free (live[e->dest->index]);
5795 live[e->dest->index] = NULL;
5799 XDELETEVEC (rpo);
5800 XDELETEVEC (bb_rpo);
5801 XDELETEVEC (last_rpo);
5802 for (i = 0; i < last_basic_block; ++i)
5803 if (live[i])
5804 sbitmap_free (live[i]);
5805 XDELETEVEC (live);
5807 return need_asserts;
5810 /* Create an ASSERT_EXPR for NAME and insert it in the location
5811 indicated by LOC. Return true if we made any edge insertions. */
5813 static bool
5814 process_assert_insertions_for (tree name, assert_locus_t loc)
5816 /* Build the comparison expression NAME_i COMP_CODE VAL. */
5817 gimple stmt;
5818 tree cond;
5819 gimple assert_stmt;
5820 edge_iterator ei;
5821 edge e;
5823 /* If we have X <=> X do not insert an assert expr for that. */
5824 if (loc->expr == loc->val)
5825 return false;
5827 cond = build2 (loc->comp_code, boolean_type_node, loc->expr, loc->val);
5828 assert_stmt = build_assert_expr_for (cond, name);
5829 if (loc->e)
5831 /* We have been asked to insert the assertion on an edge. This
5832 is used only by COND_EXPR and SWITCH_EXPR assertions. */
5833 gcc_checking_assert (gimple_code (gsi_stmt (loc->si)) == GIMPLE_COND
5834 || (gimple_code (gsi_stmt (loc->si))
5835 == GIMPLE_SWITCH));
5837 gsi_insert_on_edge (loc->e, assert_stmt);
5838 return true;
5841 /* Otherwise, we can insert right after LOC->SI iff the
5842 statement must not be the last statement in the block. */
5843 stmt = gsi_stmt (loc->si);
5844 if (!stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt))
5846 gsi_insert_after (&loc->si, assert_stmt, GSI_SAME_STMT);
5847 return false;
5850 /* If STMT must be the last statement in BB, we can only insert new
5851 assertions on the non-abnormal edge out of BB. Note that since
5852 STMT is not control flow, there may only be one non-abnormal edge
5853 out of BB. */
5854 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, loc->bb->succs)
5855 if (!(e->flags & EDGE_ABNORMAL))
5857 gsi_insert_on_edge (e, assert_stmt);
5858 return true;
5861 gcc_unreachable ();
5865 /* Process all the insertions registered for every name N_i registered
5866 in NEED_ASSERT_FOR. The list of assertions to be inserted are
5867 found in ASSERTS_FOR[i]. */
5869 static void
5870 process_assert_insertions (void)
5872 unsigned i;
5873 bitmap_iterator bi;
5874 bool update_edges_p = false;
5875 int num_asserts = 0;
5877 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5878 dump_all_asserts (dump_file);
5880 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (need_assert_for, 0, i, bi)
5882 assert_locus_t loc = asserts_for[i];
5883 gcc_assert (loc);
5885 while (loc)
5887 assert_locus_t next = loc->next;
5888 update_edges_p |= process_assert_insertions_for (ssa_name (i), loc);
5889 free (loc);
5890 loc = next;
5891 num_asserts++;
5895 if (update_edges_p)
5896 gsi_commit_edge_inserts ();
5898 statistics_counter_event (cfun, "Number of ASSERT_EXPR expressions inserted",
5899 num_asserts);
5903 /* Traverse the flowgraph looking for conditional jumps to insert range
5904 expressions. These range expressions are meant to provide information
5905 to optimizations that need to reason in terms of value ranges. They
5906 will not be expanded into RTL. For instance, given:
5908 x = ...
5909 y = ...
5910 if (x < y)
5911 y = x - 2;
5912 else
5913 x = y + 3;
5915 this pass will transform the code into:
5917 x = ...
5918 y = ...
5919 if (x < y)
5921 x = ASSERT_EXPR <x, x < y>
5922 y = x - 2
5924 else
5926 y = ASSERT_EXPR <y, x <= y>
5927 x = y + 3
5930 The idea is that once copy and constant propagation have run, other
5931 optimizations will be able to determine what ranges of values can 'x'
5932 take in different paths of the code, simply by checking the reaching
5933 definition of 'x'. */
5935 static void
5936 insert_range_assertions (void)
5938 need_assert_for = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
5939 asserts_for = XCNEWVEC (assert_locus_t, num_ssa_names);
5941 calculate_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS);
5943 if (find_assert_locations ())
5945 process_assert_insertions ();
5946 update_ssa (TODO_update_ssa_no_phi);
5949 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5951 fprintf (dump_file, "\nSSA form after inserting ASSERT_EXPRs\n");
5952 dump_function_to_file (current_function_decl, dump_file, dump_flags);
5955 free (asserts_for);
5956 BITMAP_FREE (need_assert_for);
5959 /* Checks one ARRAY_REF in REF, located at LOCUS. Ignores flexible arrays
5960 and "struct" hacks. If VRP can determine that the
5961 array subscript is a constant, check if it is outside valid
5962 range. If the array subscript is a RANGE, warn if it is
5963 non-overlapping with valid range.
5964 IGNORE_OFF_BY_ONE is true if the ARRAY_REF is inside a ADDR_EXPR. */
5966 static void
5967 check_array_ref (location_t location, tree ref, bool ignore_off_by_one)
5969 value_range_t* vr = NULL;
5970 tree low_sub, up_sub;
5971 tree low_bound, up_bound, up_bound_p1;
5972 tree base;
5974 if (TREE_NO_WARNING (ref))
5975 return;
5977 low_sub = up_sub = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 1);
5978 up_bound = array_ref_up_bound (ref);
5980 /* Can not check flexible arrays. */
5981 if (!up_bound
5982 || TREE_CODE (up_bound) != INTEGER_CST)
5983 return;
5985 /* Accesses to trailing arrays via pointers may access storage
5986 beyond the types array bounds. */
5987 base = get_base_address (ref);
5988 if (base && TREE_CODE (base) == MEM_REF)
5990 tree cref, next = NULL_TREE;
5992 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0)) != COMPONENT_REF)
5993 return;
5995 cref = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
5996 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (cref, 0))) == RECORD_TYPE)
5997 for (next = DECL_CHAIN (TREE_OPERAND (cref, 1));
5998 next && TREE_CODE (next) != FIELD_DECL;
5999 next = DECL_CHAIN (next))
6002 /* If this is the last field in a struct type or a field in a
6003 union type do not warn. */
6004 if (!next)
6005 return;
6008 low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (ref);
6009 up_bound_p1 = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, up_bound, integer_one_node);
6011 if (TREE_CODE (low_sub) == SSA_NAME)
6013 vr = get_value_range (low_sub);
6014 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE || vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
6016 low_sub = vr->type == VR_RANGE ? vr->max : vr->min;
6017 up_sub = vr->type == VR_RANGE ? vr->min : vr->max;
6021 if (vr && vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
6023 if (TREE_CODE (up_sub) == INTEGER_CST
6024 && tree_int_cst_lt (up_bound, up_sub)
6025 && TREE_CODE (low_sub) == INTEGER_CST
6026 && tree_int_cst_lt (low_sub, low_bound))
6028 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6029 "array subscript is outside array bounds");
6030 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref) = 1;
6033 else if (TREE_CODE (up_sub) == INTEGER_CST
6034 && (ignore_off_by_one
6035 ? (tree_int_cst_lt (up_bound, up_sub)
6036 && !tree_int_cst_equal (up_bound_p1, up_sub))
6037 : (tree_int_cst_lt (up_bound, up_sub)
6038 || tree_int_cst_equal (up_bound_p1, up_sub))))
6040 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6042 fprintf (dump_file, "Array bound warning for ");
6043 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE, TDF_SLIM, ref);
6044 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6046 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6047 "array subscript is above array bounds");
6048 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref) = 1;
6050 else if (TREE_CODE (low_sub) == INTEGER_CST
6051 && tree_int_cst_lt (low_sub, low_bound))
6053 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6055 fprintf (dump_file, "Array bound warning for ");
6056 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE, TDF_SLIM, ref);
6057 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6059 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6060 "array subscript is below array bounds");
6061 TREE_NO_WARNING (ref) = 1;
6065 /* Searches if the expr T, located at LOCATION computes
6066 address of an ARRAY_REF, and call check_array_ref on it. */
6068 static void
6069 search_for_addr_array (tree t, location_t location)
6071 while (TREE_CODE (t) == SSA_NAME)
6073 gimple g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (t);
6075 if (gimple_code (g) != GIMPLE_ASSIGN)
6076 return;
6078 if (get_gimple_rhs_class (gimple_assign_rhs_code (g))
6079 != GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS)
6080 return;
6082 t = gimple_assign_rhs1 (g);
6086 /* We are only interested in addresses of ARRAY_REF's. */
6087 if (TREE_CODE (t) != ADDR_EXPR)
6088 return;
6090 /* Check each ARRAY_REFs in the reference chain. */
6093 if (TREE_CODE (t) == ARRAY_REF)
6094 check_array_ref (location, t, true /*ignore_off_by_one*/);
6096 t = TREE_OPERAND (t, 0);
6098 while (handled_component_p (t));
6100 if (TREE_CODE (t) == MEM_REF
6101 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (t, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
6102 && !TREE_NO_WARNING (t))
6104 tree tem = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (t, 0), 0);
6105 tree low_bound, up_bound, el_sz;
6106 double_int idx;
6107 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) != ARRAY_TYPE
6108 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (tem))) == ARRAY_TYPE
6109 || !TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
6110 return;
6112 low_bound = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (tem)));
6113 up_bound = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (tem)));
6114 el_sz = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (tem)));
6115 if (!low_bound
6116 || TREE_CODE (low_bound) != INTEGER_CST
6117 || !up_bound
6118 || TREE_CODE (up_bound) != INTEGER_CST
6119 || !el_sz
6120 || TREE_CODE (el_sz) != INTEGER_CST)
6121 return;
6123 idx = mem_ref_offset (t);
6124 idx = idx.sdiv (tree_to_double_int (el_sz), TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
6125 if (idx.slt (double_int_zero))
6127 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6129 fprintf (dump_file, "Array bound warning for ");
6130 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE, TDF_SLIM, t);
6131 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6133 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6134 "array subscript is below array bounds");
6135 TREE_NO_WARNING (t) = 1;
6137 else if (idx.sgt (tree_to_double_int (up_bound)
6138 - tree_to_double_int (low_bound)
6139 + double_int_one))
6141 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6143 fprintf (dump_file, "Array bound warning for ");
6144 dump_generic_expr (MSG_NOTE, TDF_SLIM, t);
6145 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6147 warning_at (location, OPT_Warray_bounds,
6148 "array subscript is above array bounds");
6149 TREE_NO_WARNING (t) = 1;
6154 /* walk_tree() callback that checks if *TP is
6155 an ARRAY_REF inside an ADDR_EXPR (in which an array
6156 subscript one outside the valid range is allowed). Call
6157 check_array_ref for each ARRAY_REF found. The location is
6158 passed in DATA. */
6160 static tree
6161 check_array_bounds (tree *tp, int *walk_subtree, void *data)
6163 tree t = *tp;
6164 struct walk_stmt_info *wi = (struct walk_stmt_info *) data;
6165 location_t location;
6167 if (EXPR_HAS_LOCATION (t))
6168 location = EXPR_LOCATION (t);
6169 else
6171 location_t *locp = (location_t *) wi->info;
6172 location = *locp;
6175 *walk_subtree = TRUE;
6177 if (TREE_CODE (t) == ARRAY_REF)
6178 check_array_ref (location, t, false /*ignore_off_by_one*/);
6180 if (TREE_CODE (t) == MEM_REF
6181 || (TREE_CODE (t) == RETURN_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (t, 0)))
6182 search_for_addr_array (TREE_OPERAND (t, 0), location);
6184 if (TREE_CODE (t) == ADDR_EXPR)
6185 *walk_subtree = FALSE;
6187 return NULL_TREE;
6190 /* Walk over all statements of all reachable BBs and call check_array_bounds
6191 on them. */
6193 static void
6194 check_all_array_refs (void)
6196 basic_block bb;
6197 gimple_stmt_iterator si;
6199 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
6201 edge_iterator ei;
6202 edge e;
6203 bool executable = false;
6205 /* Skip blocks that were found to be unreachable. */
6206 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
6207 executable |= !!(e->flags & EDGE_EXECUTABLE);
6208 if (!executable)
6209 continue;
6211 for (si = gsi_start_bb (bb); !gsi_end_p (si); gsi_next (&si))
6213 gimple stmt = gsi_stmt (si);
6214 struct walk_stmt_info wi;
6215 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
6216 continue;
6218 if (is_gimple_call (stmt))
6220 size_t i;
6221 size_t n = gimple_call_num_args (stmt);
6222 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
6224 tree arg = gimple_call_arg (stmt, i);
6225 search_for_addr_array (arg, gimple_location (stmt));
6228 else
6230 memset (&wi, 0, sizeof (wi));
6231 wi.info = CONST_CAST (void *, (const void *)
6232 gimple_location_ptr (stmt));
6234 walk_gimple_op (gsi_stmt (si),
6235 check_array_bounds,
6236 &wi);
6242 /* Convert range assertion expressions into the implied copies and
6243 copy propagate away the copies. Doing the trivial copy propagation
6244 here avoids the need to run the full copy propagation pass after
6245 VRP.
6247 FIXME, this will eventually lead to copy propagation removing the
6248 names that had useful range information attached to them. For
6249 instance, if we had the assertion N_i = ASSERT_EXPR <N_j, N_j > 3>,
6250 then N_i will have the range [3, +INF].
6252 However, by converting the assertion into the implied copy
6253 operation N_i = N_j, we will then copy-propagate N_j into the uses
6254 of N_i and lose the range information. We may want to hold on to
6255 ASSERT_EXPRs a little while longer as the ranges could be used in
6256 things like jump threading.
6258 The problem with keeping ASSERT_EXPRs around is that passes after
6259 VRP need to handle them appropriately.
6261 Another approach would be to make the range information a first
6262 class property of the SSA_NAME so that it can be queried from
6263 any pass. This is made somewhat more complex by the need for
6264 multiple ranges to be associated with one SSA_NAME. */
6266 static void
6267 remove_range_assertions (void)
6269 basic_block bb;
6270 gimple_stmt_iterator si;
6272 /* Note that the BSI iterator bump happens at the bottom of the
6273 loop and no bump is necessary if we're removing the statement
6274 referenced by the current BSI. */
6275 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
6276 for (si = gsi_start_bb (bb); !gsi_end_p (si);)
6278 gimple stmt = gsi_stmt (si);
6279 gimple use_stmt;
6281 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt)
6282 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt) == ASSERT_EXPR)
6284 tree rhs = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
6285 tree var;
6286 tree cond = fold (ASSERT_EXPR_COND (rhs));
6287 use_operand_p use_p;
6288 imm_use_iterator iter;
6290 gcc_assert (cond != boolean_false_node);
6292 /* Propagate the RHS into every use of the LHS. */
6293 var = ASSERT_EXPR_VAR (rhs);
6294 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_STMT (use_stmt, iter,
6295 gimple_assign_lhs (stmt))
6296 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_ON_STMT (use_p, iter)
6298 SET_USE (use_p, var);
6299 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (var) == SSA_NAME);
6302 /* And finally, remove the copy, it is not needed. */
6303 gsi_remove (&si, true);
6304 release_defs (stmt);
6306 else
6307 gsi_next (&si);
6312 /* Return true if STMT is interesting for VRP. */
6314 static bool
6315 stmt_interesting_for_vrp (gimple stmt)
6317 if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_PHI)
6319 tree res = gimple_phi_result (stmt);
6320 return (!virtual_operand_p (res)
6321 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (res))
6322 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (res))));
6324 else if (is_gimple_assign (stmt) || is_gimple_call (stmt))
6326 tree lhs = gimple_get_lhs (stmt);
6328 /* In general, assignments with virtual operands are not useful
6329 for deriving ranges, with the obvious exception of calls to
6330 builtin functions. */
6331 if (lhs && TREE_CODE (lhs) == SSA_NAME
6332 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
6333 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs)))
6334 && ((is_gimple_call (stmt)
6335 && gimple_call_fndecl (stmt) != NULL_TREE
6336 && DECL_BUILT_IN (gimple_call_fndecl (stmt)))
6337 || !gimple_vuse (stmt)))
6338 return true;
6340 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND
6341 || gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_SWITCH)
6342 return true;
6344 return false;
6348 /* Initialize local data structures for VRP. */
6350 static void
6351 vrp_initialize (void)
6353 basic_block bb;
6355 values_propagated = false;
6356 num_vr_values = num_ssa_names;
6357 vr_value = XCNEWVEC (value_range_t *, num_vr_values);
6358 vr_phi_edge_counts = XCNEWVEC (int, num_ssa_names);
6360 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
6362 gimple_stmt_iterator si;
6364 for (si = gsi_start_phis (bb); !gsi_end_p (si); gsi_next (&si))
6366 gimple phi = gsi_stmt (si);
6367 if (!stmt_interesting_for_vrp (phi))
6369 tree lhs = PHI_RESULT (phi);
6370 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (lhs));
6371 prop_set_simulate_again (phi, false);
6373 else
6374 prop_set_simulate_again (phi, true);
6377 for (si = gsi_start_bb (bb); !gsi_end_p (si); gsi_next (&si))
6379 gimple stmt = gsi_stmt (si);
6381 /* If the statement is a control insn, then we do not
6382 want to avoid simulating the statement once. Failure
6383 to do so means that those edges will never get added. */
6384 if (stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt))
6385 prop_set_simulate_again (stmt, true);
6386 else if (!stmt_interesting_for_vrp (stmt))
6388 ssa_op_iter i;
6389 tree def;
6390 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (def, stmt, i, SSA_OP_DEF)
6391 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (def));
6392 prop_set_simulate_again (stmt, false);
6394 else
6395 prop_set_simulate_again (stmt, true);
6400 /* Return the singleton value-range for NAME or NAME. */
6402 static inline tree
6403 vrp_valueize (tree name)
6405 if (TREE_CODE (name) == SSA_NAME)
6407 value_range_t *vr = get_value_range (name);
6408 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE
6409 && (vr->min == vr->max
6410 || operand_equal_p (vr->min, vr->max, 0)))
6411 return vr->min;
6413 return name;
6416 /* Visit assignment STMT. If it produces an interesting range, record
6417 the SSA name in *OUTPUT_P. */
6419 static enum ssa_prop_result
6420 vrp_visit_assignment_or_call (gimple stmt, tree *output_p)
6422 tree def, lhs;
6423 ssa_op_iter iter;
6424 enum gimple_code code = gimple_code (stmt);
6425 lhs = gimple_get_lhs (stmt);
6427 /* We only keep track of ranges in integral and pointer types. */
6428 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == SSA_NAME
6429 && ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
6430 /* It is valid to have NULL MIN/MAX values on a type. See
6431 build_range_type. */
6432 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (lhs))
6433 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (lhs)))
6434 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs))))
6436 value_range_t new_vr = VR_INITIALIZER;
6438 /* Try folding the statement to a constant first. */
6439 tree tem = gimple_fold_stmt_to_constant (stmt, vrp_valueize);
6440 if (tem && !is_overflow_infinity (tem))
6441 set_value_range (&new_vr, VR_RANGE, tem, tem, NULL);
6442 /* Then dispatch to value-range extracting functions. */
6443 else if (code == GIMPLE_CALL)
6444 extract_range_basic (&new_vr, stmt);
6445 else
6446 extract_range_from_assignment (&new_vr, stmt);
6448 if (update_value_range (lhs, &new_vr))
6450 *output_p = lhs;
6452 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6454 fprintf (dump_file, "Found new range for ");
6455 print_generic_expr (dump_file, lhs, 0);
6456 fprintf (dump_file, ": ");
6457 dump_value_range (dump_file, &new_vr);
6458 fprintf (dump_file, "\n\n");
6461 if (new_vr.type == VR_VARYING)
6462 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
6464 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING;
6467 return SSA_PROP_NOT_INTERESTING;
6470 /* Every other statement produces no useful ranges. */
6471 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (def, stmt, iter, SSA_OP_DEF)
6472 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (def));
6474 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
6477 /* Helper that gets the value range of the SSA_NAME with version I
6478 or a symbolic range containing the SSA_NAME only if the value range
6479 is varying or undefined. */
6481 static inline value_range_t
6482 get_vr_for_comparison (int i)
6484 value_range_t vr = *get_value_range (ssa_name (i));
6486 /* If name N_i does not have a valid range, use N_i as its own
6487 range. This allows us to compare against names that may
6488 have N_i in their ranges. */
6489 if (vr.type == VR_VARYING || vr.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
6491 vr.type = VR_RANGE;
6492 vr.min = ssa_name (i);
6493 vr.max = ssa_name (i);
6496 return vr;
6499 /* Compare all the value ranges for names equivalent to VAR with VAL
6500 using comparison code COMP. Return the same value returned by
6501 compare_range_with_value, including the setting of
6502 *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P. */
6504 static tree
6505 compare_name_with_value (enum tree_code comp, tree var, tree val,
6506 bool *strict_overflow_p)
6508 bitmap_iterator bi;
6509 unsigned i;
6510 bitmap e;
6511 tree retval, t;
6512 int used_strict_overflow;
6513 bool sop;
6514 value_range_t equiv_vr;
6516 /* Get the set of equivalences for VAR. */
6517 e = get_value_range (var)->equiv;
6519 /* Start at -1. Set it to 0 if we do a comparison without relying
6520 on overflow, or 1 if all comparisons rely on overflow. */
6521 used_strict_overflow = -1;
6523 /* Compare vars' value range with val. */
6524 equiv_vr = get_vr_for_comparison (SSA_NAME_VERSION (var));
6525 sop = false;
6526 retval = compare_range_with_value (comp, &equiv_vr, val, &sop);
6527 if (retval)
6528 used_strict_overflow = sop ? 1 : 0;
6530 /* If the equiv set is empty we have done all work we need to do. */
6531 if (e == NULL)
6533 if (retval
6534 && used_strict_overflow > 0)
6535 *strict_overflow_p = true;
6536 return retval;
6539 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (e, 0, i, bi)
6541 equiv_vr = get_vr_for_comparison (i);
6542 sop = false;
6543 t = compare_range_with_value (comp, &equiv_vr, val, &sop);
6544 if (t)
6546 /* If we get different answers from different members
6547 of the equivalence set this check must be in a dead
6548 code region. Folding it to a trap representation
6549 would be correct here. For now just return don't-know. */
6550 if (retval != NULL
6551 && t != retval)
6553 retval = NULL_TREE;
6554 break;
6556 retval = t;
6558 if (!sop)
6559 used_strict_overflow = 0;
6560 else if (used_strict_overflow < 0)
6561 used_strict_overflow = 1;
6565 if (retval
6566 && used_strict_overflow > 0)
6567 *strict_overflow_p = true;
6569 return retval;
6573 /* Given a comparison code COMP and names N1 and N2, compare all the
6574 ranges equivalent to N1 against all the ranges equivalent to N2
6575 to determine the value of N1 COMP N2. Return the same value
6576 returned by compare_ranges. Set *STRICT_OVERFLOW_P to indicate
6577 whether we relied on an overflow infinity in the comparison. */
6580 static tree
6581 compare_names (enum tree_code comp, tree n1, tree n2,
6582 bool *strict_overflow_p)
6584 tree t, retval;
6585 bitmap e1, e2;
6586 bitmap_iterator bi1, bi2;
6587 unsigned i1, i2;
6588 int used_strict_overflow;
6589 static bitmap_obstack *s_obstack = NULL;
6590 static bitmap s_e1 = NULL, s_e2 = NULL;
6592 /* Compare the ranges of every name equivalent to N1 against the
6593 ranges of every name equivalent to N2. */
6594 e1 = get_value_range (n1)->equiv;
6595 e2 = get_value_range (n2)->equiv;
6597 /* Use the fake bitmaps if e1 or e2 are not available. */
6598 if (s_obstack == NULL)
6600 s_obstack = XNEW (bitmap_obstack);
6601 bitmap_obstack_initialize (s_obstack);
6602 s_e1 = BITMAP_ALLOC (s_obstack);
6603 s_e2 = BITMAP_ALLOC (s_obstack);
6605 if (e1 == NULL)
6606 e1 = s_e1;
6607 if (e2 == NULL)
6608 e2 = s_e2;
6610 /* Add N1 and N2 to their own set of equivalences to avoid
6611 duplicating the body of the loop just to check N1 and N2
6612 ranges. */
6613 bitmap_set_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
6614 bitmap_set_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
6616 /* If the equivalence sets have a common intersection, then the two
6617 names can be compared without checking their ranges. */
6618 if (bitmap_intersect_p (e1, e2))
6620 bitmap_clear_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
6621 bitmap_clear_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
6623 return (comp == EQ_EXPR || comp == GE_EXPR || comp == LE_EXPR)
6624 ? boolean_true_node
6625 : boolean_false_node;
6628 /* Start at -1. Set it to 0 if we do a comparison without relying
6629 on overflow, or 1 if all comparisons rely on overflow. */
6630 used_strict_overflow = -1;
6632 /* Otherwise, compare all the equivalent ranges. First, add N1 and
6633 N2 to their own set of equivalences to avoid duplicating the body
6634 of the loop just to check N1 and N2 ranges. */
6635 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (e1, 0, i1, bi1)
6637 value_range_t vr1 = get_vr_for_comparison (i1);
6639 t = retval = NULL_TREE;
6640 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_BITMAP (e2, 0, i2, bi2)
6642 bool sop = false;
6644 value_range_t vr2 = get_vr_for_comparison (i2);
6646 t = compare_ranges (comp, &vr1, &vr2, &sop);
6647 if (t)
6649 /* If we get different answers from different members
6650 of the equivalence set this check must be in a dead
6651 code region. Folding it to a trap representation
6652 would be correct here. For now just return don't-know. */
6653 if (retval != NULL
6654 && t != retval)
6656 bitmap_clear_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
6657 bitmap_clear_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
6658 return NULL_TREE;
6660 retval = t;
6662 if (!sop)
6663 used_strict_overflow = 0;
6664 else if (used_strict_overflow < 0)
6665 used_strict_overflow = 1;
6669 if (retval)
6671 bitmap_clear_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
6672 bitmap_clear_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
6673 if (used_strict_overflow > 0)
6674 *strict_overflow_p = true;
6675 return retval;
6679 /* None of the equivalent ranges are useful in computing this
6680 comparison. */
6681 bitmap_clear_bit (e1, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n1));
6682 bitmap_clear_bit (e2, SSA_NAME_VERSION (n2));
6683 return NULL_TREE;
6686 /* Helper function for vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv. */
6688 static tree
6689 vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges (enum tree_code code,
6690 tree op0, tree op1,
6691 bool * strict_overflow_p)
6693 value_range_t *vr0, *vr1;
6695 vr0 = (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME) ? get_value_range (op0) : NULL;
6696 vr1 = (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME) ? get_value_range (op1) : NULL;
6698 if (vr0 && vr1)
6699 return compare_ranges (code, vr0, vr1, strict_overflow_p);
6700 else if (vr0 && vr1 == NULL)
6701 return compare_range_with_value (code, vr0, op1, strict_overflow_p);
6702 else if (vr0 == NULL && vr1)
6703 return (compare_range_with_value
6704 (swap_tree_comparison (code), vr1, op0, strict_overflow_p));
6705 return NULL;
6708 /* Helper function for vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv. */
6710 static tree
6711 vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (enum tree_code code, tree op0,
6712 tree op1, bool use_equiv_p,
6713 bool *strict_overflow_p, bool *only_ranges)
6715 tree ret;
6716 if (only_ranges)
6717 *only_ranges = true;
6719 /* We only deal with integral and pointer types. */
6720 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op0))
6721 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op0)))
6722 return NULL_TREE;
6724 if (use_equiv_p)
6726 if (only_ranges
6727 && (ret = vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges
6728 (code, op0, op1, strict_overflow_p)))
6729 return ret;
6730 *only_ranges = false;
6731 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME && TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
6732 return compare_names (code, op0, op1, strict_overflow_p);
6733 else if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
6734 return compare_name_with_value (code, op0, op1, strict_overflow_p);
6735 else if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
6736 return (compare_name_with_value
6737 (swap_tree_comparison (code), op1, op0, strict_overflow_p));
6739 else
6740 return vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops_using_ranges (code, op0, op1,
6741 strict_overflow_p);
6742 return NULL_TREE;
6745 /* Given (CODE OP0 OP1) within STMT, try to simplify it based on value range
6746 information. Return NULL if the conditional can not be evaluated.
6747 The ranges of all the names equivalent with the operands in COND
6748 will be used when trying to compute the value. If the result is
6749 based on undefined signed overflow, issue a warning if
6750 appropriate. */
6752 static tree
6753 vrp_evaluate_conditional (enum tree_code code, tree op0, tree op1, gimple stmt)
6755 bool sop;
6756 tree ret;
6757 bool only_ranges;
6759 /* Some passes and foldings leak constants with overflow flag set
6760 into the IL. Avoid doing wrong things with these and bail out. */
6761 if ((TREE_CODE (op0) == INTEGER_CST
6762 && TREE_OVERFLOW (op0))
6763 || (TREE_CODE (op1) == INTEGER_CST
6764 && TREE_OVERFLOW (op1)))
6765 return NULL_TREE;
6767 sop = false;
6768 ret = vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (code, op0, op1, true, &sop,
6769 &only_ranges);
6771 if (ret && sop)
6773 enum warn_strict_overflow_code wc;
6774 const char* warnmsg;
6776 if (is_gimple_min_invariant (ret))
6778 wc = WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_CONDITIONAL;
6779 warnmsg = G_("assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
6780 "simplifying conditional to constant");
6782 else
6784 wc = WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_COMPARISON;
6785 warnmsg = G_("assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
6786 "simplifying conditional");
6789 if (issue_strict_overflow_warning (wc))
6791 location_t location;
6793 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
6794 location = input_location;
6795 else
6796 location = gimple_location (stmt);
6797 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow, "%s", warnmsg);
6801 if (warn_type_limits
6802 && ret && only_ranges
6803 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
6804 && TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
6806 /* If the comparison is being folded and the operand on the LHS
6807 is being compared against a constant value that is outside of
6808 the natural range of OP0's type, then the predicate will
6809 always fold regardless of the value of OP0. If -Wtype-limits
6810 was specified, emit a warning. */
6811 tree type = TREE_TYPE (op0);
6812 value_range_t *vr0 = get_value_range (op0);
6814 if (vr0->type != VR_VARYING
6815 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
6816 && vrp_val_is_min (vr0->min)
6817 && vrp_val_is_max (vr0->max)
6818 && is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
6820 location_t location;
6822 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
6823 location = input_location;
6824 else
6825 location = gimple_location (stmt);
6827 warning_at (location, OPT_Wtype_limits,
6828 integer_zerop (ret)
6829 ? G_("comparison always false "
6830 "due to limited range of data type")
6831 : G_("comparison always true "
6832 "due to limited range of data type"));
6836 return ret;
6840 /* Visit conditional statement STMT. If we can determine which edge
6841 will be taken out of STMT's basic block, record it in
6842 *TAKEN_EDGE_P and return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING. Otherwise, return
6843 SSA_PROP_VARYING. */
6845 static enum ssa_prop_result
6846 vrp_visit_cond_stmt (gimple stmt, edge *taken_edge_p)
6848 tree val;
6849 bool sop;
6851 *taken_edge_p = NULL;
6853 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6855 tree use;
6856 ssa_op_iter i;
6858 fprintf (dump_file, "\nVisiting conditional with predicate: ");
6859 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
6860 fprintf (dump_file, "\nWith known ranges\n");
6862 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (use, stmt, i, SSA_OP_USE)
6864 fprintf (dump_file, "\t");
6865 print_generic_expr (dump_file, use, 0);
6866 fprintf (dump_file, ": ");
6867 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr_value[SSA_NAME_VERSION (use)]);
6870 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
6873 /* Compute the value of the predicate COND by checking the known
6874 ranges of each of its operands.
6876 Note that we cannot evaluate all the equivalent ranges here
6877 because those ranges may not yet be final and with the current
6878 propagation strategy, we cannot determine when the value ranges
6879 of the names in the equivalence set have changed.
6881 For instance, given the following code fragment
6883 i_5 = PHI <8, i_13>
6885 i_14 = ASSERT_EXPR <i_5, i_5 != 0>
6886 if (i_14 == 1)
6889 Assume that on the first visit to i_14, i_5 has the temporary
6890 range [8, 8] because the second argument to the PHI function is
6891 not yet executable. We derive the range ~[0, 0] for i_14 and the
6892 equivalence set { i_5 }. So, when we visit 'if (i_14 == 1)' for
6893 the first time, since i_14 is equivalent to the range [8, 8], we
6894 determine that the predicate is always false.
6896 On the next round of propagation, i_13 is determined to be
6897 VARYING, which causes i_5 to drop down to VARYING. So, another
6898 visit to i_14 is scheduled. In this second visit, we compute the
6899 exact same range and equivalence set for i_14, namely ~[0, 0] and
6900 { i_5 }. But we did not have the previous range for i_5
6901 registered, so vrp_visit_assignment thinks that the range for
6902 i_14 has not changed. Therefore, the predicate 'if (i_14 == 1)'
6903 is not visited again, which stops propagation from visiting
6904 statements in the THEN clause of that if().
6906 To properly fix this we would need to keep the previous range
6907 value for the names in the equivalence set. This way we would've
6908 discovered that from one visit to the other i_5 changed from
6909 range [8, 8] to VR_VARYING.
6911 However, fixing this apparent limitation may not be worth the
6912 additional checking. Testing on several code bases (GCC, DLV,
6913 MICO, TRAMP3D and SPEC2000) showed that doing this results in
6914 4 more predicates folded in SPEC. */
6915 sop = false;
6917 val = vrp_evaluate_conditional_warnv_with_ops (gimple_cond_code (stmt),
6918 gimple_cond_lhs (stmt),
6919 gimple_cond_rhs (stmt),
6920 false, &sop, NULL);
6921 if (val)
6923 if (!sop)
6924 *taken_edge_p = find_taken_edge (gimple_bb (stmt), val);
6925 else
6927 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6928 fprintf (dump_file,
6929 "\nIgnoring predicate evaluation because "
6930 "it assumes that signed overflow is undefined");
6931 val = NULL_TREE;
6935 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6937 fprintf (dump_file, "\nPredicate evaluates to: ");
6938 if (val == NULL_TREE)
6939 fprintf (dump_file, "DON'T KNOW\n");
6940 else
6941 print_generic_stmt (dump_file, val, 0);
6944 return (*taken_edge_p) ? SSA_PROP_INTERESTING : SSA_PROP_VARYING;
6947 /* Searches the case label vector VEC for the index *IDX of the CASE_LABEL
6948 that includes the value VAL. The search is restricted to the range
6949 [START_IDX, n - 1] where n is the size of VEC.
6951 If there is a CASE_LABEL for VAL, its index is placed in IDX and true is
6952 returned.
6954 If there is no CASE_LABEL for VAL and there is one that is larger than VAL,
6955 it is placed in IDX and false is returned.
6957 If VAL is larger than any CASE_LABEL, n is placed on IDX and false is
6958 returned. */
6960 static bool
6961 find_case_label_index (gimple stmt, size_t start_idx, tree val, size_t *idx)
6963 size_t n = gimple_switch_num_labels (stmt);
6964 size_t low, high;
6966 /* Find case label for minimum of the value range or the next one.
6967 At each iteration we are searching in [low, high - 1]. */
6969 for (low = start_idx, high = n; high != low; )
6971 tree t;
6972 int cmp;
6973 /* Note that i != high, so we never ask for n. */
6974 size_t i = (high + low) / 2;
6975 t = gimple_switch_label (stmt, i);
6977 /* Cache the result of comparing CASE_LOW and val. */
6978 cmp = tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_LOW (t), val);
6980 if (cmp == 0)
6982 /* Ranges cannot be empty. */
6983 *idx = i;
6984 return true;
6986 else if (cmp > 0)
6987 high = i;
6988 else
6990 low = i + 1;
6991 if (CASE_HIGH (t) != NULL
6992 && tree_int_cst_compare (CASE_HIGH (t), val) >= 0)
6994 *idx = i;
6995 return true;
7000 *idx = high;
7001 return false;
7004 /* Searches the case label vector VEC for the range of CASE_LABELs that is used
7005 for values between MIN and MAX. The first index is placed in MIN_IDX. The
7006 last index is placed in MAX_IDX. If the range of CASE_LABELs is empty
7007 then MAX_IDX < MIN_IDX.
7008 Returns true if the default label is not needed. */
7010 static bool
7011 find_case_label_range (gimple stmt, tree min, tree max, size_t *min_idx,
7012 size_t *max_idx)
7014 size_t i, j;
7015 bool min_take_default = !find_case_label_index (stmt, 1, min, &i);
7016 bool max_take_default = !find_case_label_index (stmt, i, max, &j);
7018 if (i == j
7019 && min_take_default
7020 && max_take_default)
7022 /* Only the default case label reached.
7023 Return an empty range. */
7024 *min_idx = 1;
7025 *max_idx = 0;
7026 return false;
7028 else
7030 bool take_default = min_take_default || max_take_default;
7031 tree low, high;
7032 size_t k;
7034 if (max_take_default)
7035 j--;
7037 /* If the case label range is continuous, we do not need
7038 the default case label. Verify that. */
7039 high = CASE_LOW (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i));
7040 if (CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i)))
7041 high = CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i));
7042 for (k = i + 1; k <= j; ++k)
7044 low = CASE_LOW (gimple_switch_label (stmt, k));
7045 if (!integer_onep (int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, low, high)))
7047 take_default = true;
7048 break;
7050 high = low;
7051 if (CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, k)))
7052 high = CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, k));
7055 *min_idx = i;
7056 *max_idx = j;
7057 return !take_default;
7061 /* Searches the case label vector VEC for the ranges of CASE_LABELs that are
7062 used in range VR. The indices are placed in MIN_IDX1, MAX_IDX, MIN_IDX2 and
7063 MAX_IDX2. If the ranges of CASE_LABELs are empty then MAX_IDX1 < MIN_IDX1.
7064 Returns true if the default label is not needed. */
7066 static bool
7067 find_case_label_ranges (gimple stmt, value_range_t *vr, size_t *min_idx1,
7068 size_t *max_idx1, size_t *min_idx2,
7069 size_t *max_idx2)
7071 size_t i, j, k, l;
7072 unsigned int n = gimple_switch_num_labels (stmt);
7073 bool take_default;
7074 tree case_low, case_high;
7075 tree min = vr->min, max = vr->max;
7077 gcc_checking_assert (vr->type == VR_RANGE || vr->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE);
7079 take_default = !find_case_label_range (stmt, min, max, &i, &j);
7081 /* Set second range to emtpy. */
7082 *min_idx2 = 1;
7083 *max_idx2 = 0;
7085 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
7087 *min_idx1 = i;
7088 *max_idx1 = j;
7089 return !take_default;
7092 /* Set first range to all case labels. */
7093 *min_idx1 = 1;
7094 *max_idx1 = n - 1;
7096 if (i > j)
7097 return false;
7099 /* Make sure all the values of case labels [i , j] are contained in
7100 range [MIN, MAX]. */
7101 case_low = CASE_LOW (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i));
7102 case_high = CASE_HIGH (gimple_switch_label (stmt, j));
7103 if (tree_int_cst_compare (case_low, min) < 0)
7104 i += 1;
7105 if (case_high != NULL_TREE
7106 && tree_int_cst_compare (max, case_high) < 0)
7107 j -= 1;
7109 if (i > j)
7110 return false;
7112 /* If the range spans case labels [i, j], the corresponding anti-range spans
7113 the labels [1, i - 1] and [j + 1, n - 1]. */
7114 k = j + 1;
7115 l = n - 1;
7116 if (k > l)
7118 k = 1;
7119 l = 0;
7122 j = i - 1;
7123 i = 1;
7124 if (i > j)
7126 i = k;
7127 j = l;
7128 k = 1;
7129 l = 0;
7132 *min_idx1 = i;
7133 *max_idx1 = j;
7134 *min_idx2 = k;
7135 *max_idx2 = l;
7136 return false;
7139 /* Visit switch statement STMT. If we can determine which edge
7140 will be taken out of STMT's basic block, record it in
7141 *TAKEN_EDGE_P and return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING. Otherwise, return
7142 SSA_PROP_VARYING. */
7144 static enum ssa_prop_result
7145 vrp_visit_switch_stmt (gimple stmt, edge *taken_edge_p)
7147 tree op, val;
7148 value_range_t *vr;
7149 size_t i = 0, j = 0, k, l;
7150 bool take_default;
7152 *taken_edge_p = NULL;
7153 op = gimple_switch_index (stmt);
7154 if (TREE_CODE (op) != SSA_NAME)
7155 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
7157 vr = get_value_range (op);
7158 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7160 fprintf (dump_file, "\nVisiting switch expression with operand ");
7161 print_generic_expr (dump_file, op, 0);
7162 fprintf (dump_file, " with known range ");
7163 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr);
7164 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7167 if ((vr->type != VR_RANGE
7168 && vr->type != VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7169 || symbolic_range_p (vr))
7170 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
7172 /* Find the single edge that is taken from the switch expression. */
7173 take_default = !find_case_label_ranges (stmt, vr, &i, &j, &k, &l);
7175 /* Check if the range spans no CASE_LABEL. If so, we only reach the default
7176 label */
7177 if (j < i)
7179 gcc_assert (take_default);
7180 val = gimple_switch_default_label (stmt);
7182 else
7184 /* Check if labels with index i to j and maybe the default label
7185 are all reaching the same label. */
7187 val = gimple_switch_label (stmt, i);
7188 if (take_default
7189 && CASE_LABEL (gimple_switch_default_label (stmt))
7190 != CASE_LABEL (val))
7192 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7193 fprintf (dump_file, " not a single destination for this "
7194 "range\n");
7195 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
7197 for (++i; i <= j; ++i)
7199 if (CASE_LABEL (gimple_switch_label (stmt, i)) != CASE_LABEL (val))
7201 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7202 fprintf (dump_file, " not a single destination for this "
7203 "range\n");
7204 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
7207 for (; k <= l; ++k)
7209 if (CASE_LABEL (gimple_switch_label (stmt, k)) != CASE_LABEL (val))
7211 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7212 fprintf (dump_file, " not a single destination for this "
7213 "range\n");
7214 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
7219 *taken_edge_p = find_edge (gimple_bb (stmt),
7220 label_to_block (CASE_LABEL (val)));
7222 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7224 fprintf (dump_file, " will take edge to ");
7225 print_generic_stmt (dump_file, CASE_LABEL (val), 0);
7228 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING;
7232 /* Evaluate statement STMT. If the statement produces a useful range,
7233 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING and record the SSA name with the
7234 interesting range into *OUTPUT_P.
7236 If STMT is a conditional branch and we can determine its truth
7237 value, the taken edge is recorded in *TAKEN_EDGE_P.
7239 If STMT produces a varying value, return SSA_PROP_VARYING. */
7241 static enum ssa_prop_result
7242 vrp_visit_stmt (gimple stmt, edge *taken_edge_p, tree *output_p)
7244 tree def;
7245 ssa_op_iter iter;
7247 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7249 fprintf (dump_file, "\nVisiting statement:\n");
7250 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, dump_flags);
7251 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7254 if (!stmt_interesting_for_vrp (stmt))
7255 gcc_assert (stmt_ends_bb_p (stmt));
7256 else if (is_gimple_assign (stmt) || is_gimple_call (stmt))
7258 /* In general, assignments with virtual operands are not useful
7259 for deriving ranges, with the obvious exception of calls to
7260 builtin functions. */
7261 if ((is_gimple_call (stmt)
7262 && gimple_call_fndecl (stmt) != NULL_TREE
7263 && DECL_BUILT_IN (gimple_call_fndecl (stmt)))
7264 || !gimple_vuse (stmt))
7265 return vrp_visit_assignment_or_call (stmt, output_p);
7267 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND)
7268 return vrp_visit_cond_stmt (stmt, taken_edge_p);
7269 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_SWITCH)
7270 return vrp_visit_switch_stmt (stmt, taken_edge_p);
7272 /* All other statements produce nothing of interest for VRP, so mark
7273 their outputs varying and prevent further simulation. */
7274 FOR_EACH_SSA_TREE_OPERAND (def, stmt, iter, SSA_OP_DEF)
7275 set_value_range_to_varying (get_value_range (def));
7277 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
7280 /* Union the two value-ranges { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX } and
7281 { VR1TYPE, VR0MIN, VR0MAX } and store the result
7282 in { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX }. This may not be the smallest
7283 possible such range. The resulting range is not canonicalized. */
7285 static void
7286 union_ranges (enum value_range_type *vr0type,
7287 tree *vr0min, tree *vr0max,
7288 enum value_range_type vr1type,
7289 tree vr1min, tree vr1max)
7291 bool mineq = operand_equal_p (*vr0min, vr1min, 0);
7292 bool maxeq = operand_equal_p (*vr0max, vr1max, 0);
7294 /* [] is vr0, () is vr1 in the following classification comments. */
7295 if (mineq && maxeq)
7297 /* [( )] */
7298 if (*vr0type == vr1type)
7299 /* Nothing to do for equal ranges. */
7301 else if ((*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7302 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7303 || (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7304 && vr1type == VR_RANGE))
7306 /* For anti-range with range union the result is varying. */
7307 goto give_up;
7309 else
7310 gcc_unreachable ();
7312 else if (operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1min) == 1
7313 || operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0min) == 1)
7315 /* [ ] ( ) or ( ) [ ]
7316 If the ranges have an empty intersection, result of the union
7317 operation is the anti-range or if both are anti-ranges
7318 it covers all. */
7319 if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7320 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7321 goto give_up;
7322 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7323 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7325 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7326 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7328 *vr0type = vr1type;
7329 *vr0min = vr1min;
7330 *vr0max = vr1max;
7332 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7333 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7335 /* The result is the convex hull of both ranges. */
7336 if (operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1min) == 1)
7338 /* If the result can be an anti-range, create one. */
7339 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST
7340 && TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST
7341 && vrp_val_is_min (*vr0min)
7342 && vrp_val_is_max (vr1max))
7344 tree min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
7345 *vr0max, integer_one_node);
7346 tree max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
7347 vr1min, integer_one_node);
7348 if (!operand_less_p (max, min))
7350 *vr0type = VR_ANTI_RANGE;
7351 *vr0min = min;
7352 *vr0max = max;
7354 else
7355 *vr0max = vr1max;
7357 else
7358 *vr0max = vr1max;
7360 else
7362 /* If the result can be an anti-range, create one. */
7363 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST
7364 && TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST
7365 && vrp_val_is_min (vr1min)
7366 && vrp_val_is_max (*vr0max))
7368 tree min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
7369 vr1max, integer_one_node);
7370 tree max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
7371 *vr0min, integer_one_node);
7372 if (!operand_less_p (max, min))
7374 *vr0type = VR_ANTI_RANGE;
7375 *vr0min = min;
7376 *vr0max = max;
7378 else
7379 *vr0min = vr1min;
7381 else
7382 *vr0min = vr1min;
7385 else
7386 gcc_unreachable ();
7388 else if ((maxeq || operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0max) == 1)
7389 && (mineq || operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1min) == 1))
7391 /* [ ( ) ] or [( ) ] or [ ( )] */
7392 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7393 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7395 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7396 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7398 *vr0type = vr1type;
7399 *vr0min = vr1min;
7400 *vr0max = vr1max;
7402 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7403 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7405 /* Arbitrarily choose the right or left gap. */
7406 if (!mineq && TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST)
7407 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr1min, integer_one_node);
7408 else if (!maxeq && TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST)
7409 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr1max, integer_one_node);
7410 else
7411 goto give_up;
7413 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7414 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7415 /* The result covers everything. */
7416 goto give_up;
7417 else
7418 gcc_unreachable ();
7420 else if ((maxeq || operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1max) == 1)
7421 && (mineq || operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0min) == 1))
7423 /* ( [ ] ) or ([ ] ) or ( [ ]) */
7424 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7425 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7427 *vr0type = vr1type;
7428 *vr0min = vr1min;
7429 *vr0max = vr1max;
7431 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7432 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7434 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7435 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7437 *vr0type = VR_ANTI_RANGE;
7438 if (!mineq && TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST)
7440 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *vr0min, integer_one_node);
7441 *vr0min = vr1min;
7443 else if (!maxeq && TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST)
7445 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, *vr0max, integer_one_node);
7446 *vr0max = vr1max;
7448 else
7449 goto give_up;
7451 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7452 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7453 /* The result covers everything. */
7454 goto give_up;
7455 else
7456 gcc_unreachable ();
7458 else if ((operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0max) == 1
7459 || operand_equal_p (vr1min, *vr0max, 0))
7460 && operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1min) == 1
7461 && operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1max) == 1)
7463 /* [ ( ] ) or [ ]( ) */
7464 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7465 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7466 *vr0max = vr1max;
7467 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7468 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7469 *vr0min = vr1min;
7470 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7471 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7473 if (TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST)
7474 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr1min, integer_one_node);
7475 else
7476 goto give_up;
7478 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7479 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7481 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST)
7483 *vr0type = vr1type;
7484 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, *vr0max, integer_one_node);
7485 *vr0max = vr1max;
7487 else
7488 goto give_up;
7490 else
7491 gcc_unreachable ();
7493 else if ((operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1max) == 1
7494 || operand_equal_p (*vr0min, vr1max, 0))
7495 && operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0min) == 1
7496 && operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0max) == 1)
7498 /* ( [ ) ] or ( )[ ] */
7499 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7500 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7501 *vr0min = vr1min;
7502 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7503 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7504 *vr0max = vr1max;
7505 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7506 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7508 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST)
7509 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr1max, integer_one_node);
7510 else
7511 goto give_up;
7513 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7514 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7516 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST)
7518 *vr0type = vr1type;
7519 *vr0min = vr1min;
7520 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *vr0min, integer_one_node);
7522 else
7523 goto give_up;
7525 else
7526 gcc_unreachable ();
7528 else
7529 goto give_up;
7531 return;
7533 give_up:
7534 *vr0type = VR_VARYING;
7535 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
7536 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
7539 /* Intersect the two value-ranges { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX } and
7540 { VR1TYPE, VR0MIN, VR0MAX } and store the result
7541 in { *VR0TYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX }. This may not be the smallest
7542 possible such range. The resulting range is not canonicalized. */
7544 static void
7545 intersect_ranges (enum value_range_type *vr0type,
7546 tree *vr0min, tree *vr0max,
7547 enum value_range_type vr1type,
7548 tree vr1min, tree vr1max)
7550 bool mineq = operand_equal_p (*vr0min, vr1min, 0);
7551 bool maxeq = operand_equal_p (*vr0max, vr1max, 0);
7553 /* [] is vr0, () is vr1 in the following classification comments. */
7554 if (mineq && maxeq)
7556 /* [( )] */
7557 if (*vr0type == vr1type)
7558 /* Nothing to do for equal ranges. */
7560 else if ((*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7561 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7562 || (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7563 && vr1type == VR_RANGE))
7565 /* For anti-range with range intersection the result is empty. */
7566 *vr0type = VR_UNDEFINED;
7567 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
7568 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
7570 else
7571 gcc_unreachable ();
7573 else if (operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1min) == 1
7574 || operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0min) == 1)
7576 /* [ ] ( ) or ( ) [ ]
7577 If the ranges have an empty intersection, the result of the
7578 intersect operation is the range for intersecting an
7579 anti-range with a range or empty when intersecting two ranges. */
7580 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7581 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7583 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7584 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7586 *vr0type = vr1type;
7587 *vr0min = vr1min;
7588 *vr0max = vr1max;
7590 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7591 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7593 *vr0type = VR_UNDEFINED;
7594 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
7595 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
7597 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7598 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7600 /* If the anti-ranges are adjacent to each other merge them. */
7601 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST
7602 && TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST
7603 && operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1min) == 1
7604 && integer_onep (int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
7605 vr1min, *vr0max)))
7606 *vr0max = vr1max;
7607 else if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST
7608 && TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST
7609 && operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0min) == 1
7610 && integer_onep (int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
7611 *vr0min, vr1max)))
7612 *vr0min = vr1min;
7613 /* Else arbitrarily take VR0. */
7616 else if ((maxeq || operand_less_p (vr1max, *vr0max) == 1)
7617 && (mineq || operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1min) == 1))
7619 /* [ ( ) ] or [( ) ] or [ ( )] */
7620 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7621 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7623 /* If both are ranges the result is the inner one. */
7624 *vr0type = vr1type;
7625 *vr0min = vr1min;
7626 *vr0max = vr1max;
7628 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7629 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7631 /* Choose the right gap if the left one is empty. */
7632 if (mineq)
7634 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST)
7635 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr1max, integer_one_node);
7636 else
7637 *vr0min = vr1max;
7639 /* Choose the left gap if the right one is empty. */
7640 else if (maxeq)
7642 if (TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST)
7643 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr1min,
7644 integer_one_node);
7645 else
7646 *vr0max = vr1min;
7648 /* Choose the anti-range if the range is effectively varying. */
7649 else if (vrp_val_is_min (*vr0min)
7650 && vrp_val_is_max (*vr0max))
7652 *vr0type = vr1type;
7653 *vr0min = vr1min;
7654 *vr0max = vr1max;
7656 /* Else choose the range. */
7658 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7659 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7660 /* If both are anti-ranges the result is the outer one. */
7662 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7663 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7665 /* The intersection is empty. */
7666 *vr0type = VR_UNDEFINED;
7667 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
7668 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
7670 else
7671 gcc_unreachable ();
7673 else if ((maxeq || operand_less_p (*vr0max, vr1max) == 1)
7674 && (mineq || operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0min) == 1))
7676 /* ( [ ] ) or ([ ] ) or ( [ ]) */
7677 if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7678 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7679 /* Choose the inner range. */
7681 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7682 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7684 /* Choose the right gap if the left is empty. */
7685 if (mineq)
7687 *vr0type = VR_RANGE;
7688 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST)
7689 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, *vr0max,
7690 integer_one_node);
7691 else
7692 *vr0min = *vr0max;
7693 *vr0max = vr1max;
7695 /* Choose the left gap if the right is empty. */
7696 else if (maxeq)
7698 *vr0type = VR_RANGE;
7699 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST)
7700 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *vr0min,
7701 integer_one_node);
7702 else
7703 *vr0max = *vr0min;
7704 *vr0min = vr1min;
7706 /* Choose the anti-range if the range is effectively varying. */
7707 else if (vrp_val_is_min (vr1min)
7708 && vrp_val_is_max (vr1max))
7710 /* Else choose the range. */
7711 else
7713 *vr0type = vr1type;
7714 *vr0min = vr1min;
7715 *vr0max = vr1max;
7718 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7719 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7721 /* If both are anti-ranges the result is the outer one. */
7722 *vr0type = vr1type;
7723 *vr0min = vr1min;
7724 *vr0max = vr1max;
7726 else if (vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7727 && *vr0type == VR_RANGE)
7729 /* The intersection is empty. */
7730 *vr0type = VR_UNDEFINED;
7731 *vr0min = NULL_TREE;
7732 *vr0max = NULL_TREE;
7734 else
7735 gcc_unreachable ();
7737 else if ((operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0max) == 1
7738 || operand_equal_p (vr1min, *vr0max, 0))
7739 && operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1min) == 1)
7741 /* [ ( ] ) or [ ]( ) */
7742 if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7743 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7744 *vr0max = vr1max;
7745 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7746 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7747 *vr0min = vr1min;
7748 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7749 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7751 if (TREE_CODE (vr1min) == INTEGER_CST)
7752 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, vr1min,
7753 integer_one_node);
7754 else
7755 *vr0max = vr1min;
7757 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7758 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7760 *vr0type = VR_RANGE;
7761 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0max) == INTEGER_CST)
7762 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, *vr0max,
7763 integer_one_node);
7764 else
7765 *vr0min = *vr0max;
7766 *vr0max = vr1max;
7768 else
7769 gcc_unreachable ();
7771 else if ((operand_less_p (*vr0min, vr1max) == 1
7772 || operand_equal_p (*vr0min, vr1max, 0))
7773 && operand_less_p (vr1min, *vr0min) == 1)
7775 /* ( [ ) ] or ( )[ ] */
7776 if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7777 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7778 *vr0min = vr1min;
7779 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7780 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7781 *vr0max = vr1max;
7782 else if (*vr0type == VR_RANGE
7783 && vr1type == VR_ANTI_RANGE)
7785 if (TREE_CODE (vr1max) == INTEGER_CST)
7786 *vr0min = int_const_binop (PLUS_EXPR, vr1max,
7787 integer_one_node);
7788 else
7789 *vr0min = vr1max;
7791 else if (*vr0type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7792 && vr1type == VR_RANGE)
7794 *vr0type = VR_RANGE;
7795 if (TREE_CODE (*vr0min) == INTEGER_CST)
7796 *vr0max = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *vr0min,
7797 integer_one_node);
7798 else
7799 *vr0max = *vr0min;
7800 *vr0min = vr1min;
7802 else
7803 gcc_unreachable ();
7806 /* As a fallback simply use { *VRTYPE, *VR0MIN, *VR0MAX } as
7807 result for the intersection. That's always a conservative
7808 correct estimate. */
7810 return;
7814 /* Intersect the two value-ranges *VR0 and *VR1 and store the result
7815 in *VR0. This may not be the smallest possible such range. */
7817 static void
7818 vrp_intersect_ranges_1 (value_range_t *vr0, value_range_t *vr1)
7820 value_range_t saved;
7822 /* If either range is VR_VARYING the other one wins. */
7823 if (vr1->type == VR_VARYING)
7824 return;
7825 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
7827 copy_value_range (vr0, vr1);
7828 return;
7831 /* When either range is VR_UNDEFINED the resulting range is
7832 VR_UNDEFINED, too. */
7833 if (vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
7834 return;
7835 if (vr1->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
7837 set_value_range_to_undefined (vr0);
7838 return;
7841 /* Save the original vr0 so we can return it as conservative intersection
7842 result when our worker turns things to varying. */
7843 saved = *vr0;
7844 intersect_ranges (&vr0->type, &vr0->min, &vr0->max,
7845 vr1->type, vr1->min, vr1->max);
7846 /* Make sure to canonicalize the result though as the inversion of a
7847 VR_RANGE can still be a VR_RANGE. */
7848 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr0, vr0->type,
7849 vr0->min, vr0->max, vr0->equiv);
7850 /* If that failed, use the saved original VR0. */
7851 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
7853 *vr0 = saved;
7854 return;
7856 /* If the result is VR_UNDEFINED there is no need to mess with
7857 the equivalencies. */
7858 if (vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
7859 return;
7861 /* The resulting set of equivalences for range intersection is the union of
7862 the two sets. */
7863 if (vr0->equiv && vr1->equiv && vr0->equiv != vr1->equiv)
7864 bitmap_ior_into (vr0->equiv, vr1->equiv);
7865 else if (vr1->equiv && !vr0->equiv)
7866 bitmap_copy (vr0->equiv, vr1->equiv);
7869 static void
7870 vrp_intersect_ranges (value_range_t *vr0, value_range_t *vr1)
7872 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7874 fprintf (dump_file, "Intersecting\n ");
7875 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr0);
7876 fprintf (dump_file, "\nand\n ");
7877 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr1);
7878 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7880 vrp_intersect_ranges_1 (vr0, vr1);
7881 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7883 fprintf (dump_file, "to\n ");
7884 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr0);
7885 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7889 /* Meet operation for value ranges. Given two value ranges VR0 and
7890 VR1, store in VR0 a range that contains both VR0 and VR1. This
7891 may not be the smallest possible such range. */
7893 static void
7894 vrp_meet_1 (value_range_t *vr0, value_range_t *vr1)
7896 value_range_t saved;
7898 if (vr0->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
7900 set_value_range (vr0, vr1->type, vr1->min, vr1->max, vr1->equiv);
7901 return;
7904 if (vr1->type == VR_UNDEFINED)
7906 /* VR0 already has the resulting range. */
7907 return;
7910 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
7912 /* Nothing to do. VR0 already has the resulting range. */
7913 return;
7916 if (vr1->type == VR_VARYING)
7918 set_value_range_to_varying (vr0);
7919 return;
7922 saved = *vr0;
7923 union_ranges (&vr0->type, &vr0->min, &vr0->max,
7924 vr1->type, vr1->min, vr1->max);
7925 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
7927 /* Failed to find an efficient meet. Before giving up and setting
7928 the result to VARYING, see if we can at least derive a useful
7929 anti-range. FIXME, all this nonsense about distinguishing
7930 anti-ranges from ranges is necessary because of the odd
7931 semantics of range_includes_zero_p and friends. */
7932 if (((saved.type == VR_RANGE
7933 && range_includes_zero_p (saved.min, saved.max) == 0)
7934 || (saved.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7935 && range_includes_zero_p (saved.min, saved.max) == 1))
7936 && ((vr1->type == VR_RANGE
7937 && range_includes_zero_p (vr1->min, vr1->max) == 0)
7938 || (vr1->type == VR_ANTI_RANGE
7939 && range_includes_zero_p (vr1->min, vr1->max) == 1)))
7941 set_value_range_to_nonnull (vr0, TREE_TYPE (saved.min));
7943 /* Since this meet operation did not result from the meeting of
7944 two equivalent names, VR0 cannot have any equivalences. */
7945 if (vr0->equiv)
7946 bitmap_clear (vr0->equiv);
7947 return;
7950 set_value_range_to_varying (vr0);
7951 return;
7953 set_and_canonicalize_value_range (vr0, vr0->type, vr0->min, vr0->max,
7954 vr0->equiv);
7955 if (vr0->type == VR_VARYING)
7956 return;
7958 /* The resulting set of equivalences is always the intersection of
7959 the two sets. */
7960 if (vr0->equiv && vr1->equiv && vr0->equiv != vr1->equiv)
7961 bitmap_and_into (vr0->equiv, vr1->equiv);
7962 else if (vr0->equiv && !vr1->equiv)
7963 bitmap_clear (vr0->equiv);
7966 static void
7967 vrp_meet (value_range_t *vr0, value_range_t *vr1)
7969 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7971 fprintf (dump_file, "Meeting\n ");
7972 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr0);
7973 fprintf (dump_file, "\nand\n ");
7974 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr1);
7975 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7977 vrp_meet_1 (vr0, vr1);
7978 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7980 fprintf (dump_file, "to\n ");
7981 dump_value_range (dump_file, vr0);
7982 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7987 /* Visit all arguments for PHI node PHI that flow through executable
7988 edges. If a valid value range can be derived from all the incoming
7989 value ranges, set a new range for the LHS of PHI. */
7991 static enum ssa_prop_result
7992 vrp_visit_phi_node (gimple phi)
7994 size_t i;
7995 tree lhs = PHI_RESULT (phi);
7996 value_range_t *lhs_vr = get_value_range (lhs);
7997 value_range_t vr_result = VR_INITIALIZER;
7998 bool first = true;
7999 int edges, old_edges;
8000 struct loop *l;
8002 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8004 fprintf (dump_file, "\nVisiting PHI node: ");
8005 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, phi, 0, dump_flags);
8008 edges = 0;
8009 for (i = 0; i < gimple_phi_num_args (phi); i++)
8011 edge e = gimple_phi_arg_edge (phi, i);
8013 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8015 fprintf (dump_file,
8016 "\n Argument #%d (%d -> %d %sexecutable)\n",
8017 (int) i, e->src->index, e->dest->index,
8018 (e->flags & EDGE_EXECUTABLE) ? "" : "not ");
8021 if (e->flags & EDGE_EXECUTABLE)
8023 tree arg = PHI_ARG_DEF (phi, i);
8024 value_range_t vr_arg;
8026 ++edges;
8028 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
8030 vr_arg = *(get_value_range (arg));
8031 /* Do not allow equivalences or symbolic ranges to leak in from
8032 backedges. That creates invalid equivalencies.
8033 See PR53465 and PR54767. */
8034 if (e->flags & EDGE_DFS_BACK
8035 && (vr_arg.type == VR_RANGE
8036 || vr_arg.type == VR_ANTI_RANGE))
8038 vr_arg.equiv = NULL;
8039 if (symbolic_range_p (&vr_arg))
8041 vr_arg.type = VR_VARYING;
8042 vr_arg.min = NULL_TREE;
8043 vr_arg.max = NULL_TREE;
8047 else
8049 if (is_overflow_infinity (arg))
8051 arg = copy_node (arg);
8052 TREE_OVERFLOW (arg) = 0;
8055 vr_arg.type = VR_RANGE;
8056 vr_arg.min = arg;
8057 vr_arg.max = arg;
8058 vr_arg.equiv = NULL;
8061 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8063 fprintf (dump_file, "\t");
8064 print_generic_expr (dump_file, arg, dump_flags);
8065 fprintf (dump_file, "\n\tValue: ");
8066 dump_value_range (dump_file, &vr_arg);
8067 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
8070 if (first)
8071 copy_value_range (&vr_result, &vr_arg);
8072 else
8073 vrp_meet (&vr_result, &vr_arg);
8074 first = false;
8076 if (vr_result.type == VR_VARYING)
8077 break;
8081 if (vr_result.type == VR_VARYING)
8082 goto varying;
8083 else if (vr_result.type == VR_UNDEFINED)
8084 goto update_range;
8086 old_edges = vr_phi_edge_counts[SSA_NAME_VERSION (lhs)];
8087 vr_phi_edge_counts[SSA_NAME_VERSION (lhs)] = edges;
8089 /* To prevent infinite iterations in the algorithm, derive ranges
8090 when the new value is slightly bigger or smaller than the
8091 previous one. We don't do this if we have seen a new executable
8092 edge; this helps us avoid an overflow infinity for conditionals
8093 which are not in a loop. If the old value-range was VR_UNDEFINED
8094 use the updated range and iterate one more time. */
8095 if (edges > 0
8096 && gimple_phi_num_args (phi) > 1
8097 && edges == old_edges
8098 && lhs_vr->type != VR_UNDEFINED)
8100 int cmp_min = compare_values (lhs_vr->min, vr_result.min);
8101 int cmp_max = compare_values (lhs_vr->max, vr_result.max);
8103 /* For non VR_RANGE or for pointers fall back to varying if
8104 the range changed. */
8105 if ((lhs_vr->type != VR_RANGE || vr_result.type != VR_RANGE
8106 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (lhs)))
8107 && (cmp_min != 0 || cmp_max != 0))
8108 goto varying;
8110 /* If the new minimum is smaller or larger than the previous
8111 one, go all the way to -INF. In the first case, to avoid
8112 iterating millions of times to reach -INF, and in the
8113 other case to avoid infinite bouncing between different
8114 minimums. */
8115 if (cmp_min > 0 || cmp_min < 0)
8117 if (!needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result.min))
8118 || !vrp_var_may_overflow (lhs, phi))
8119 vr_result.min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (vr_result.min));
8120 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result.min)))
8121 vr_result.min =
8122 negative_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result.min));
8125 /* Similarly, if the new maximum is smaller or larger than
8126 the previous one, go all the way to +INF. */
8127 if (cmp_max < 0 || cmp_max > 0)
8129 if (!needs_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result.max))
8130 || !vrp_var_may_overflow (lhs, phi))
8131 vr_result.max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (vr_result.max));
8132 else if (supports_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result.max)))
8133 vr_result.max =
8134 positive_overflow_infinity (TREE_TYPE (vr_result.max));
8137 /* If we dropped either bound to +-INF then if this is a loop
8138 PHI node SCEV may known more about its value-range. */
8139 if ((cmp_min > 0 || cmp_min < 0
8140 || cmp_max < 0 || cmp_max > 0)
8141 && current_loops
8142 && (l = loop_containing_stmt (phi))
8143 && l->header == gimple_bb (phi))
8144 adjust_range_with_scev (&vr_result, l, phi, lhs);
8146 /* If we will end up with a (-INF, +INF) range, set it to
8147 VARYING. Same if the previous max value was invalid for
8148 the type and we end up with vr_result.min > vr_result.max. */
8149 if ((vrp_val_is_max (vr_result.max)
8150 && vrp_val_is_min (vr_result.min))
8151 || compare_values (vr_result.min,
8152 vr_result.max) > 0)
8153 goto varying;
8156 /* If the new range is different than the previous value, keep
8157 iterating. */
8158 update_range:
8159 if (update_value_range (lhs, &vr_result))
8161 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8163 fprintf (dump_file, "Found new range for ");
8164 print_generic_expr (dump_file, lhs, 0);
8165 fprintf (dump_file, ": ");
8166 dump_value_range (dump_file, &vr_result);
8167 fprintf (dump_file, "\n\n");
8170 return SSA_PROP_INTERESTING;
8173 /* Nothing changed, don't add outgoing edges. */
8174 return SSA_PROP_NOT_INTERESTING;
8176 /* No match found. Set the LHS to VARYING. */
8177 varying:
8178 set_value_range_to_varying (lhs_vr);
8179 return SSA_PROP_VARYING;
8182 /* Simplify boolean operations if the source is known
8183 to be already a boolean. */
8184 static bool
8185 simplify_truth_ops_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple stmt)
8187 enum tree_code rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
8188 tree lhs, op0, op1;
8189 bool need_conversion;
8191 /* We handle only !=/== case here. */
8192 gcc_assert (rhs_code == EQ_EXPR || rhs_code == NE_EXPR);
8194 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
8195 if (!op_with_boolean_value_range_p (op0))
8196 return false;
8198 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
8199 if (!op_with_boolean_value_range_p (op1))
8200 return false;
8202 /* Reduce number of cases to handle to NE_EXPR. As there is no
8203 BIT_XNOR_EXPR we cannot replace A == B with a single statement. */
8204 if (rhs_code == EQ_EXPR)
8206 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == INTEGER_CST)
8207 op1 = int_const_binop (BIT_XOR_EXPR, op1, integer_one_node);
8208 else
8209 return false;
8212 lhs = gimple_assign_lhs (stmt);
8213 need_conversion
8214 = !useless_type_conversion_p (TREE_TYPE (lhs), TREE_TYPE (op0));
8216 /* Make sure to not sign-extend a 1-bit 1 when converting the result. */
8217 if (need_conversion
8218 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op0))
8219 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (op0)) == 1
8220 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (lhs)) > 1)
8221 return false;
8223 /* For A != 0 we can substitute A itself. */
8224 if (integer_zerop (op1))
8225 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi,
8226 need_conversion
8227 ? NOP_EXPR : TREE_CODE (op0),
8228 op0, NULL_TREE);
8229 /* For A != B we substitute A ^ B. Either with conversion. */
8230 else if (need_conversion)
8232 tree tem = make_ssa_name (TREE_TYPE (op0), NULL);
8233 gimple newop = gimple_build_assign_with_ops (BIT_XOR_EXPR, tem, op0, op1);
8234 gsi_insert_before (gsi, newop, GSI_SAME_STMT);
8235 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi, NOP_EXPR, tem, NULL_TREE);
8237 /* Or without. */
8238 else
8239 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi, BIT_XOR_EXPR, op0, op1);
8240 update_stmt (gsi_stmt (*gsi));
8242 return true;
8245 /* Simplify a division or modulo operator to a right shift or
8246 bitwise and if the first operand is unsigned or is greater
8247 than zero and the second operand is an exact power of two. */
8249 static bool
8250 simplify_div_or_mod_using_ranges (gimple stmt)
8252 enum tree_code rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
8253 tree val = NULL;
8254 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
8255 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
8256 value_range_t *vr = get_value_range (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt));
8258 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op0)))
8260 val = integer_one_node;
8262 else
8264 bool sop = false;
8266 val = compare_range_with_value (GE_EXPR, vr, integer_zero_node, &sop);
8268 if (val
8269 && sop
8270 && integer_onep (val)
8271 && issue_strict_overflow_warning (WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_MISC))
8273 location_t location;
8275 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
8276 location = input_location;
8277 else
8278 location = gimple_location (stmt);
8279 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow,
8280 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
8281 "simplifying %</%> or %<%%%> to %<>>%> or %<&%>");
8285 if (val && integer_onep (val))
8287 tree t;
8289 if (rhs_code == TRUNC_DIV_EXPR)
8291 t = build_int_cst (integer_type_node, tree_log2 (op1));
8292 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt, RSHIFT_EXPR);
8293 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, op0);
8294 gimple_assign_set_rhs2 (stmt, t);
8296 else
8298 t = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op1), 1);
8299 t = int_const_binop (MINUS_EXPR, op1, t);
8300 t = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (op0), t);
8302 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt, BIT_AND_EXPR);
8303 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, op0);
8304 gimple_assign_set_rhs2 (stmt, t);
8307 update_stmt (stmt);
8308 return true;
8311 return false;
8314 /* If the operand to an ABS_EXPR is >= 0, then eliminate the
8315 ABS_EXPR. If the operand is <= 0, then simplify the
8316 ABS_EXPR into a NEGATE_EXPR. */
8318 static bool
8319 simplify_abs_using_ranges (gimple stmt)
8321 tree val = NULL;
8322 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
8323 tree type = TREE_TYPE (op);
8324 value_range_t *vr = get_value_range (op);
8326 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8328 val = integer_zero_node;
8330 else if (vr)
8332 bool sop = false;
8334 val = compare_range_with_value (LE_EXPR, vr, integer_zero_node, &sop);
8335 if (!val)
8337 sop = false;
8338 val = compare_range_with_value (GE_EXPR, vr, integer_zero_node,
8339 &sop);
8341 if (val)
8343 if (integer_zerop (val))
8344 val = integer_one_node;
8345 else if (integer_onep (val))
8346 val = integer_zero_node;
8350 if (val
8351 && (integer_onep (val) || integer_zerop (val)))
8353 if (sop && issue_strict_overflow_warning (WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_MISC))
8355 location_t location;
8357 if (!gimple_has_location (stmt))
8358 location = input_location;
8359 else
8360 location = gimple_location (stmt);
8361 warning_at (location, OPT_Wstrict_overflow,
8362 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
8363 "simplifying %<abs (X)%> to %<X%> or %<-X%>");
8366 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, op);
8367 if (integer_onep (val))
8368 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt, NEGATE_EXPR);
8369 else
8370 gimple_assign_set_rhs_code (stmt, SSA_NAME);
8371 update_stmt (stmt);
8372 return true;
8376 return false;
8379 /* Optimize away redundant BIT_AND_EXPR and BIT_IOR_EXPR.
8380 If all the bits that are being cleared by & are already
8381 known to be zero from VR, or all the bits that are being
8382 set by | are already known to be one from VR, the bit
8383 operation is redundant. */
8385 static bool
8386 simplify_bit_ops_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple stmt)
8388 tree op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
8389 tree op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
8390 tree op = NULL_TREE;
8391 value_range_t vr0 = VR_INITIALIZER;
8392 value_range_t vr1 = VR_INITIALIZER;
8393 double_int may_be_nonzero0, may_be_nonzero1;
8394 double_int must_be_nonzero0, must_be_nonzero1;
8395 double_int mask;
8397 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
8398 vr0 = *(get_value_range (op0));
8399 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op0))
8400 set_value_range_to_value (&vr0, op0, NULL);
8401 else
8402 return false;
8404 if (TREE_CODE (op1) == SSA_NAME)
8405 vr1 = *(get_value_range (op1));
8406 else if (is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
8407 set_value_range_to_value (&vr1, op1, NULL);
8408 else
8409 return false;
8411 if (!zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (&vr0, &may_be_nonzero0, &must_be_nonzero0))
8412 return false;
8413 if (!zero_nonzero_bits_from_vr (&vr1, &may_be_nonzero1, &must_be_nonzero1))
8414 return false;
8416 switch (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt))
8418 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8419 mask = may_be_nonzero0.and_not (must_be_nonzero1);
8420 if (mask.is_zero ())
8422 op = op0;
8423 break;
8425 mask = may_be_nonzero1.and_not (must_be_nonzero0);
8426 if (mask.is_zero ())
8428 op = op1;
8429 break;
8431 break;
8432 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8433 mask = may_be_nonzero0.and_not (must_be_nonzero1);
8434 if (mask.is_zero ())
8436 op = op1;
8437 break;
8439 mask = may_be_nonzero1.and_not (must_be_nonzero0);
8440 if (mask.is_zero ())
8442 op = op0;
8443 break;
8445 break;
8446 default:
8447 gcc_unreachable ();
8450 if (op == NULL_TREE)
8451 return false;
8453 gimple_assign_set_rhs_with_ops (gsi, TREE_CODE (op), op, NULL);
8454 update_stmt (gsi_stmt (*gsi));
8455 return true;
8458 /* We are comparing trees OP0 and OP1 using COND_CODE. OP0 has
8459 a known value range VR.
8461 If there is one and only one value which will satisfy the
8462 conditional, then return that value. Else return NULL. */
8464 static tree
8465 test_for_singularity (enum tree_code cond_code, tree op0,
8466 tree op1, value_range_t *vr)
8468 tree min = NULL;
8469 tree max = NULL;
8471 /* Extract minimum/maximum values which satisfy the
8472 the conditional as it was written. */
8473 if (cond_code == LE_EXPR || cond_code == LT_EXPR)
8475 /* This should not be negative infinity; there is no overflow
8476 here. */
8477 min = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (op0));
8479 max = op1;
8480 if (cond_code == LT_EXPR && !is_overflow_infinity (max))
8482 tree one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op0), 1);
8483 max = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (op0), max, one);
8484 if (EXPR_P (max))
8485 TREE_NO_WARNING (max) = 1;
8488 else if (cond_code == GE_EXPR || cond_code == GT_EXPR)
8490 /* This should not be positive infinity; there is no overflow
8491 here. */
8492 max = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (op0));
8494 min = op1;
8495 if (cond_code == GT_EXPR && !is_overflow_infinity (min))
8497 tree one = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (op0), 1);
8498 min = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (op0), min, one);
8499 if (EXPR_P (min))
8500 TREE_NO_WARNING (min) = 1;
8504 /* Now refine the minimum and maximum values using any
8505 value range information we have for op0. */
8506 if (min && max)
8508 if (compare_values (vr->min, min) == 1)
8509 min = vr->min;
8510 if (compare_values (vr->max, max) == -1)
8511 max = vr->max;
8513 /* If the new min/max values have converged to a single value,
8514 then there is only one value which can satisfy the condition,
8515 return that value. */
8516 if (operand_equal_p (min, max, 0) && is_gimple_min_invariant (min))
8517 return min;
8519 return NULL;
8522 /* Simplify a conditional using a relational operator to an equality
8523 test if the range information indicates only one value can satisfy
8524 the original conditional. */
8526 static bool
8527 simplify_cond_using_ranges (gimple stmt)
8529 tree op0 = gimple_cond_lhs (stmt);
8530 tree op1 = gimple_cond_rhs (stmt);
8531 enum tree_code cond_code = gimple_cond_code (stmt);
8533 if (cond_code != NE_EXPR
8534 && cond_code != EQ_EXPR
8535 && TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME
8536 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (op0))
8537 && is_gimple_min_invariant (op1))
8539 value_range_t *vr = get_value_range (op0);
8541 /* If we have range information for OP0, then we might be
8542 able to simplify this conditional. */
8543 if (vr->type == VR_RANGE)
8545 tree new_tree = test_for_singularity (cond_code, op0, op1, vr);
8547 if (new_tree)
8549 if (dump_file)
8551 fprintf (dump_file, "Simplified relational ");
8552 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
8553 fprintf (dump_file, " into ");
8556 gimple_cond_set_code (stmt, EQ_EXPR);
8557 gimple_cond_set_lhs (stmt, op0);
8558 gimple_cond_set_rhs (stmt, new_tree);
8560 update_stmt (stmt);
8562 if (dump_file)
8564 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
8565 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
8568 return true;
8571 /* Try again after inverting the condition. We only deal
8572 with integral types here, so no need to worry about
8573 issues with inverting FP comparisons. */
8574 cond_code = invert_tree_comparison (cond_code, false);
8575 new_tree = test_for_singularity (cond_code, op0, op1, vr);
8577 if (new_tree)
8579 if (dump_file)
8581 fprintf (dump_file, "Simplified relational ");
8582 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
8583 fprintf (dump_file, " into ");
8586 gimple_cond_set_code (stmt, NE_EXPR);
8587 gimple_cond_set_lhs (stmt, op0);
8588 gimple_cond_set_rhs (stmt, new_tree);
8590 update_stmt (stmt);
8592 if (dump_file)
8594 print_gimple_stmt (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
8595 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
8598 return true;
8603 return false;
8606 /* Simplify a switch statement using the value range of the switch
8607 argument. */
8609 static bool
8610 simplify_switch_using_ranges (gimple stmt)
8612 tree op = gimple_switch_index (stmt);
8613 value_range_t *vr;
8614 bool take_default;
8615 edge e;
8616 edge_iterator ei;
8617 size_t i = 0, j = 0, n, n2;
8618 tree vec2;
8619 switch_update su;
8620 size_t k = 1, l = 0;
8622 if (TREE_CODE (op) == SSA_NAME)
8624 vr = get_value_range (op);
8626 /* We can only handle integer ranges. */
8627 if ((vr->type != VR_RANGE
8628 && vr->type != VR_ANTI_RANGE)
8629 || symbolic_range_p (vr))
8630 return false;
8632 /* Find case label for min/max of the value range. */
8633 take_default = !find_case_label_ranges (stmt, vr, &i, &j, &k, &l);
8635 else if (TREE_CODE (op) == INTEGER_CST)
8637 take_default = !find_case_label_index (stmt, 1, op, &i);
8638 if (take_default)
8640 i = 1;
8641 j = 0;
8643 else
8645 j = i;
8648 else
8649 return false;
8651 n = gimple_switch_num_labels (stmt);
8653 /* Bail out if this is just all edges taken. */
8654 if (i == 1
8655 && j == n - 1
8656 && take_default)
8657 return false;
8659 /* Build a new vector of taken case labels. */
8660 vec2 = make_tree_vec (j - i + 1 + l - k + 1 + (int)take_default);
8661 n2 = 0;
8663 /* Add the default edge, if necessary. */
8664 if (take_default)
8665 TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2, n2++) = gimple_switch_default_label (stmt);
8667 for (; i <= j; ++i, ++n2)
8668 TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2, n2) = gimple_switch_label (stmt, i);
8670 for (; k <= l; ++k, ++n2)
8671 TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2, n2) = gimple_switch_label (stmt, k);
8673 /* Mark needed edges. */
8674 for (i = 0; i < n2; ++i)
8676 e = find_edge (gimple_bb (stmt),
8677 label_to_block (CASE_LABEL (TREE_VEC_ELT (vec2, i))));
8678 e->aux = (void *)-1;
8681 /* Queue not needed edges for later removal. */
8682 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, gimple_bb (stmt)->succs)
8684 if (e->aux == (void *)-1)
8686 e->aux = NULL;
8687 continue;
8690 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
8692 fprintf (dump_file, "removing unreachable case label\n");
8694 to_remove_edges.safe_push (e);
8695 e->flags &= ~EDGE_EXECUTABLE;
8698 /* And queue an update for the stmt. */
8699 su.stmt = stmt;
8700 su.vec = vec2;
8701 to_update_switch_stmts.safe_push (su);
8702 return false;
8705 /* Simplify an integral conversion from an SSA name in STMT. */
8707 static bool
8708 simplify_conversion_using_ranges (gimple stmt)
8710 tree innerop, middleop, finaltype;
8711 gimple def_stmt;
8712 value_range_t *innervr;
8713 bool inner_unsigned_p, middle_unsigned_p, final_unsigned_p;
8714 unsigned inner_prec, middle_prec, final_prec;
8715 double_int innermin, innermed, innermax, middlemin, middlemed, middlemax;
8717 finaltype = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (stmt));
8718 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (finaltype))
8719 return false;
8720 middleop = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
8721 def_stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (middleop);
8722 if (!is_gimple_assign (def_stmt)
8723 || !CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt)))
8724 return false;
8725 innerop = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt);
8726 if (TREE_CODE (innerop) != SSA_NAME)
8727 return false;
8729 /* Get the value-range of the inner operand. */
8730 innervr = get_value_range (innerop);
8731 if (innervr->type != VR_RANGE
8732 || TREE_CODE (innervr->min) != INTEGER_CST
8733 || TREE_CODE (innervr->max) != INTEGER_CST)
8734 return false;
8736 /* Simulate the conversion chain to check if the result is equal if
8737 the middle conversion is removed. */
8738 innermin = tree_to_double_int (innervr->min);
8739 innermax = tree_to_double_int (innervr->max);
8741 inner_prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (innerop));
8742 middle_prec = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (middleop));
8743 final_prec = TYPE_PRECISION (finaltype);
8745 /* If the first conversion is not injective, the second must not
8746 be widening. */
8747 if ((innermax - innermin).ugt (double_int::mask (middle_prec))
8748 && middle_prec < final_prec)
8749 return false;
8750 /* We also want a medium value so that we can track the effect that
8751 narrowing conversions with sign change have. */
8752 inner_unsigned_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (innerop));
8753 if (inner_unsigned_p)
8754 innermed = double_int::mask (inner_prec).lrshift (1, inner_prec);
8755 else
8756 innermed = double_int_zero;
8757 if (innermin.cmp (innermed, inner_unsigned_p) >= 0
8758 || innermed.cmp (innermax, inner_unsigned_p) >= 0)
8759 innermed = innermin;
8761 middle_unsigned_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (middleop));
8762 middlemin = innermin.ext (middle_prec, middle_unsigned_p);
8763 middlemed = innermed.ext (middle_prec, middle_unsigned_p);
8764 middlemax = innermax.ext (middle_prec, middle_unsigned_p);
8766 /* Require that the final conversion applied to both the original
8767 and the intermediate range produces the same result. */
8768 final_unsigned_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (finaltype);
8769 if (middlemin.ext (final_prec, final_unsigned_p)
8770 != innermin.ext (final_prec, final_unsigned_p)
8771 || middlemed.ext (final_prec, final_unsigned_p)
8772 != innermed.ext (final_prec, final_unsigned_p)
8773 || middlemax.ext (final_prec, final_unsigned_p)
8774 != innermax.ext (final_prec, final_unsigned_p))
8775 return false;
8777 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, innerop);
8778 update_stmt (stmt);
8779 return true;
8782 /* Return whether the value range *VR fits in an integer type specified
8783 by PRECISION and UNSIGNED_P. */
8785 static bool
8786 range_fits_type_p (value_range_t *vr, unsigned precision, bool unsigned_p)
8788 tree src_type;
8789 unsigned src_precision;
8790 double_int tem;
8792 /* We can only handle integral and pointer types. */
8793 src_type = TREE_TYPE (vr->min);
8794 if (!INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (src_type)
8795 && !POINTER_TYPE_P (src_type))
8796 return false;
8798 /* An extension is fine unless VR is signed and unsigned_p,
8799 and so is an identity transform. */
8800 src_precision = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (vr->min));
8801 if ((src_precision < precision
8802 && !(unsigned_p && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (src_type)))
8803 || (src_precision == precision
8804 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (src_type) == unsigned_p))
8805 return true;
8807 /* Now we can only handle ranges with constant bounds. */
8808 if (vr->type != VR_RANGE
8809 || TREE_CODE (vr->min) != INTEGER_CST
8810 || TREE_CODE (vr->max) != INTEGER_CST)
8811 return false;
8813 /* For sign changes, the MSB of the double_int has to be clear.
8814 An unsigned value with its MSB set cannot be represented by
8815 a signed double_int, while a negative value cannot be represented
8816 by an unsigned double_int. */
8817 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (src_type) != unsigned_p
8818 && (TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (vr->min) | TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (vr->max)) < 0)
8819 return false;
8821 /* Then we can perform the conversion on both ends and compare
8822 the result for equality. */
8823 tem = tree_to_double_int (vr->min).ext (precision, unsigned_p);
8824 if (tree_to_double_int (vr->min) != tem)
8825 return false;
8826 tem = tree_to_double_int (vr->max).ext (precision, unsigned_p);
8827 if (tree_to_double_int (vr->max) != tem)
8828 return false;
8830 return true;
8833 /* Simplify a conversion from integral SSA name to float in STMT. */
8835 static bool
8836 simplify_float_conversion_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi, gimple stmt)
8838 tree rhs1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
8839 value_range_t *vr = get_value_range (rhs1);
8840 enum machine_mode fltmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (stmt)));
8841 enum machine_mode mode;
8842 tree tem;
8843 gimple conv;
8845 /* We can only handle constant ranges. */
8846 if (vr->type != VR_RANGE
8847 || TREE_CODE (vr->min) != INTEGER_CST
8848 || TREE_CODE (vr->max) != INTEGER_CST)
8849 return false;
8851 /* First check if we can use a signed type in place of an unsigned. */
8852 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))
8853 && (can_float_p (fltmode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)), 0)
8854 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8855 && range_fits_type_p (vr, GET_MODE_PRECISION
8856 (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))), 0))
8857 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1));
8858 /* If we can do the conversion in the current input mode do nothing. */
8859 else if (can_float_p (fltmode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)),
8860 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8861 return false;
8862 /* Otherwise search for a mode we can use, starting from the narrowest
8863 integer mode available. */
8864 else
8866 mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
8869 /* If we cannot do a signed conversion to float from mode
8870 or if the value-range does not fit in the signed type
8871 try with a wider mode. */
8872 if (can_float_p (fltmode, mode, 0) != CODE_FOR_nothing
8873 && range_fits_type_p (vr, GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode), 0))
8874 break;
8876 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode);
8877 /* But do not widen the input. Instead leave that to the
8878 optabs expansion code. */
8879 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
8880 return false;
8882 while (mode != VOIDmode);
8883 if (mode == VOIDmode)
8884 return false;
8887 /* It works, insert a truncation or sign-change before the
8888 float conversion. */
8889 tem = make_ssa_name (build_nonstandard_integer_type
8890 (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode), 0), NULL);
8891 conv = gimple_build_assign_with_ops (NOP_EXPR, tem, rhs1, NULL_TREE);
8892 gsi_insert_before (gsi, conv, GSI_SAME_STMT);
8893 gimple_assign_set_rhs1 (stmt, tem);
8894 update_stmt (stmt);
8896 return true;
8899 /* Simplify STMT using ranges if possible. */
8901 static bool
8902 simplify_stmt_using_ranges (gimple_stmt_iterator *gsi)
8904 gimple stmt = gsi_stmt (*gsi);
8905 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt))
8907 enum tree_code rhs_code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
8908 tree rhs1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
8910 switch (rhs_code)
8912 case EQ_EXPR:
8913 case NE_EXPR:
8914 /* Transform EQ_EXPR, NE_EXPR into BIT_XOR_EXPR or identity
8915 if the RHS is zero or one, and the LHS are known to be boolean
8916 values. */
8917 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
8918 return simplify_truth_ops_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
8919 break;
8921 /* Transform TRUNC_DIV_EXPR and TRUNC_MOD_EXPR into RSHIFT_EXPR
8922 and BIT_AND_EXPR respectively if the first operand is greater
8923 than zero and the second operand is an exact power of two. */
8924 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
8925 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
8926 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))
8927 && integer_pow2p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt)))
8928 return simplify_div_or_mod_using_ranges (stmt);
8929 break;
8931 /* Transform ABS (X) into X or -X as appropriate. */
8932 case ABS_EXPR:
8933 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1) == SSA_NAME
8934 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
8935 return simplify_abs_using_ranges (stmt);
8936 break;
8938 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8939 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8940 /* Optimize away BIT_AND_EXPR and BIT_IOR_EXPR
8941 if all the bits being cleared are already cleared or
8942 all the bits being set are already set. */
8943 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
8944 return simplify_bit_ops_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
8945 break;
8947 CASE_CONVERT:
8948 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1) == SSA_NAME
8949 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
8950 return simplify_conversion_using_ranges (stmt);
8951 break;
8953 case FLOAT_EXPR:
8954 if (TREE_CODE (rhs1) == SSA_NAME
8955 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1)))
8956 return simplify_float_conversion_using_ranges (gsi, stmt);
8957 break;
8959 default:
8960 break;
8963 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND)
8964 return simplify_cond_using_ranges (stmt);
8965 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_SWITCH)
8966 return simplify_switch_using_ranges (stmt);
8968 return false;
8971 /* If the statement pointed by SI has a predicate whose value can be
8972 computed using the value range information computed by VRP, compute
8973 its value and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
8975 static bool
8976 fold_predicate_in (gimple_stmt_iterator *si)
8978 bool assignment_p = false;
8979 tree val;
8980 gimple stmt = gsi_stmt (*si);
8982 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt)
8983 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt)) == tcc_comparison)
8985 assignment_p = true;
8986 val = vrp_evaluate_conditional (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt),
8987 gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt),
8988 gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt),
8989 stmt);
8991 else if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND)
8992 val = vrp_evaluate_conditional (gimple_cond_code (stmt),
8993 gimple_cond_lhs (stmt),
8994 gimple_cond_rhs (stmt),
8995 stmt);
8996 else
8997 return false;
8999 if (val)
9001 if (assignment_p)
9002 val = fold_convert (gimple_expr_type (stmt), val);
9004 if (dump_file)
9006 fprintf (dump_file, "Folding predicate ");
9007 print_gimple_expr (dump_file, stmt, 0, 0);
9008 fprintf (dump_file, " to ");
9009 print_generic_expr (dump_file, val, 0);
9010 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
9013 if (is_gimple_assign (stmt))
9014 gimple_assign_set_rhs_from_tree (si, val);
9015 else
9017 gcc_assert (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_COND);
9018 if (integer_zerop (val))
9019 gimple_cond_make_false (stmt);
9020 else if (integer_onep (val))
9021 gimple_cond_make_true (stmt);
9022 else
9023 gcc_unreachable ();
9026 return true;
9029 return false;
9032 /* Callback for substitute_and_fold folding the stmt at *SI. */
9034 static bool
9035 vrp_fold_stmt (gimple_stmt_iterator *si)
9037 if (fold_predicate_in (si))
9038 return true;
9040 return simplify_stmt_using_ranges (si);
9043 /* Stack of dest,src equivalency pairs that need to be restored after
9044 each attempt to thread a block's incoming edge to an outgoing edge.
9046 A NULL entry is used to mark the end of pairs which need to be
9047 restored. */
9048 static vec<tree> equiv_stack;
9050 /* A trivial wrapper so that we can present the generic jump threading
9051 code with a simple API for simplifying statements. STMT is the
9052 statement we want to simplify, WITHIN_STMT provides the location
9053 for any overflow warnings. */
9055 static tree
9056 simplify_stmt_for_jump_threading (gimple stmt, gimple within_stmt)
9058 /* We only use VRP information to simplify conditionals. This is
9059 overly conservative, but it's unclear if doing more would be
9060 worth the compile time cost. */
9061 if (gimple_code (stmt) != GIMPLE_COND)
9062 return NULL;
9064 return vrp_evaluate_conditional (gimple_cond_code (stmt),
9065 gimple_cond_lhs (stmt),
9066 gimple_cond_rhs (stmt), within_stmt);
9069 /* Blocks which have more than one predecessor and more than
9070 one successor present jump threading opportunities, i.e.,
9071 when the block is reached from a specific predecessor, we
9072 may be able to determine which of the outgoing edges will
9073 be traversed. When this optimization applies, we are able
9074 to avoid conditionals at runtime and we may expose secondary
9075 optimization opportunities.
9077 This routine is effectively a driver for the generic jump
9078 threading code. It basically just presents the generic code
9079 with edges that may be suitable for jump threading.
9081 Unlike DOM, we do not iterate VRP if jump threading was successful.
9082 While iterating may expose new opportunities for VRP, it is expected
9083 those opportunities would be very limited and the compile time cost
9084 to expose those opportunities would be significant.
9086 As jump threading opportunities are discovered, they are registered
9087 for later realization. */
9089 static void
9090 identify_jump_threads (void)
9092 basic_block bb;
9093 gimple dummy;
9094 int i;
9095 edge e;
9097 /* Ugh. When substituting values earlier in this pass we can
9098 wipe the dominance information. So rebuild the dominator
9099 information as we need it within the jump threading code. */
9100 calculate_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS);
9102 /* We do not allow VRP information to be used for jump threading
9103 across a back edge in the CFG. Otherwise it becomes too
9104 difficult to avoid eliminating loop exit tests. Of course
9105 EDGE_DFS_BACK is not accurate at this time so we have to
9106 recompute it. */
9107 mark_dfs_back_edges ();
9109 /* Do not thread across edges we are about to remove. Just marking
9110 them as EDGE_DFS_BACK will do. */
9111 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_remove_edges, i, e)
9112 e->flags |= EDGE_DFS_BACK;
9114 /* Allocate our unwinder stack to unwind any temporary equivalences
9115 that might be recorded. */
9116 equiv_stack.create (20);
9118 /* To avoid lots of silly node creation, we create a single
9119 conditional and just modify it in-place when attempting to
9120 thread jumps. */
9121 dummy = gimple_build_cond (EQ_EXPR,
9122 integer_zero_node, integer_zero_node,
9123 NULL, NULL);
9125 /* Walk through all the blocks finding those which present a
9126 potential jump threading opportunity. We could set this up
9127 as a dominator walker and record data during the walk, but
9128 I doubt it's worth the effort for the classes of jump
9129 threading opportunities we are trying to identify at this
9130 point in compilation. */
9131 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
9133 gimple last;
9135 /* If the generic jump threading code does not find this block
9136 interesting, then there is nothing to do. */
9137 if (! potentially_threadable_block (bb))
9138 continue;
9140 /* We only care about blocks ending in a COND_EXPR. While there
9141 may be some value in handling SWITCH_EXPR here, I doubt it's
9142 terribly important. */
9143 last = gsi_stmt (gsi_last_bb (bb));
9145 /* We're basically looking for a switch or any kind of conditional with
9146 integral or pointer type arguments. Note the type of the second
9147 argument will be the same as the first argument, so no need to
9148 check it explicitly. */
9149 if (gimple_code (last) == GIMPLE_SWITCH
9150 || (gimple_code (last) == GIMPLE_COND
9151 && TREE_CODE (gimple_cond_lhs (last)) == SSA_NAME
9152 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (last)))
9153 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (gimple_cond_lhs (last))))
9154 && (TREE_CODE (gimple_cond_rhs (last)) == SSA_NAME
9155 || is_gimple_min_invariant (gimple_cond_rhs (last)))))
9157 edge_iterator ei;
9159 /* We've got a block with multiple predecessors and multiple
9160 successors which also ends in a suitable conditional or
9161 switch statement. For each predecessor, see if we can thread
9162 it to a specific successor. */
9163 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
9165 /* Do not thread across back edges or abnormal edges
9166 in the CFG. */
9167 if (e->flags & (EDGE_DFS_BACK | EDGE_COMPLEX))
9168 continue;
9170 thread_across_edge (dummy, e, true, &equiv_stack,
9171 simplify_stmt_for_jump_threading);
9176 /* We do not actually update the CFG or SSA graphs at this point as
9177 ASSERT_EXPRs are still in the IL and cfg cleanup code does not yet
9178 handle ASSERT_EXPRs gracefully. */
9181 /* We identified all the jump threading opportunities earlier, but could
9182 not transform the CFG at that time. This routine transforms the
9183 CFG and arranges for the dominator tree to be rebuilt if necessary.
9185 Note the SSA graph update will occur during the normal TODO
9186 processing by the pass manager. */
9187 static void
9188 finalize_jump_threads (void)
9190 thread_through_all_blocks (false);
9191 equiv_stack.release ();
9195 /* Traverse all the blocks folding conditionals with known ranges. */
9197 static void
9198 vrp_finalize (void)
9200 size_t i;
9202 values_propagated = true;
9204 if (dump_file)
9206 fprintf (dump_file, "\nValue ranges after VRP:\n\n");
9207 dump_all_value_ranges (dump_file);
9208 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
9211 substitute_and_fold (op_with_constant_singleton_value_range,
9212 vrp_fold_stmt, false);
9214 if (warn_array_bounds)
9215 check_all_array_refs ();
9217 /* We must identify jump threading opportunities before we release
9218 the datastructures built by VRP. */
9219 identify_jump_threads ();
9221 /* Free allocated memory. */
9222 for (i = 0; i < num_vr_values; i++)
9223 if (vr_value[i])
9225 BITMAP_FREE (vr_value[i]->equiv);
9226 free (vr_value[i]);
9229 free (vr_value);
9230 free (vr_phi_edge_counts);
9232 /* So that we can distinguish between VRP data being available
9233 and not available. */
9234 vr_value = NULL;
9235 vr_phi_edge_counts = NULL;
9239 /* Main entry point to VRP (Value Range Propagation). This pass is
9240 loosely based on J. R. C. Patterson, ``Accurate Static Branch
9241 Prediction by Value Range Propagation,'' in SIGPLAN Conference on
9242 Programming Language Design and Implementation, pp. 67-78, 1995.
9243 Also available at http://citeseer.ist.psu.edu/patterson95accurate.html
9245 This is essentially an SSA-CCP pass modified to deal with ranges
9246 instead of constants.
9248 While propagating ranges, we may find that two or more SSA name
9249 have equivalent, though distinct ranges. For instance,
9251 1 x_9 = p_3->a;
9252 2 p_4 = ASSERT_EXPR <p_3, p_3 != 0>
9253 3 if (p_4 == q_2)
9254 4 p_5 = ASSERT_EXPR <p_4, p_4 == q_2>;
9255 5 endif
9256 6 if (q_2)
9258 In the code above, pointer p_5 has range [q_2, q_2], but from the
9259 code we can also determine that p_5 cannot be NULL and, if q_2 had
9260 a non-varying range, p_5's range should also be compatible with it.
9262 These equivalences are created by two expressions: ASSERT_EXPR and
9263 copy operations. Since p_5 is an assertion on p_4, and p_4 was the
9264 result of another assertion, then we can use the fact that p_5 and
9265 p_4 are equivalent when evaluating p_5's range.
9267 Together with value ranges, we also propagate these equivalences
9268 between names so that we can take advantage of information from
9269 multiple ranges when doing final replacement. Note that this
9270 equivalency relation is transitive but not symmetric.
9272 In the example above, p_5 is equivalent to p_4, q_2 and p_3, but we
9273 cannot assert that q_2 is equivalent to p_5 because q_2 may be used
9274 in contexts where that assertion does not hold (e.g., in line 6).
9276 TODO, the main difference between this pass and Patterson's is that
9277 we do not propagate edge probabilities. We only compute whether
9278 edges can be taken or not. That is, instead of having a spectrum
9279 of jump probabilities between 0 and 1, we only deal with 0, 1 and
9280 DON'T KNOW. In the future, it may be worthwhile to propagate
9281 probabilities to aid branch prediction. */
9283 static unsigned int
9284 execute_vrp (void)
9286 int i;
9287 edge e;
9288 switch_update *su;
9290 loop_optimizer_init (LOOPS_NORMAL | LOOPS_HAVE_RECORDED_EXITS);
9291 rewrite_into_loop_closed_ssa (NULL, TODO_update_ssa);
9292 scev_initialize ();
9294 /* ??? This ends up using stale EDGE_DFS_BACK for liveness computation.
9295 Inserting assertions may split edges which will invalidate
9296 EDGE_DFS_BACK. */
9297 insert_range_assertions ();
9299 to_remove_edges.create (10);
9300 to_update_switch_stmts.create (5);
9301 threadedge_initialize_values ();
9303 /* For visiting PHI nodes we need EDGE_DFS_BACK computed. */
9304 mark_dfs_back_edges ();
9306 vrp_initialize ();
9307 ssa_propagate (vrp_visit_stmt, vrp_visit_phi_node);
9308 vrp_finalize ();
9310 free_numbers_of_iterations_estimates ();
9312 /* ASSERT_EXPRs must be removed before finalizing jump threads
9313 as finalizing jump threads calls the CFG cleanup code which
9314 does not properly handle ASSERT_EXPRs. */
9315 remove_range_assertions ();
9317 /* If we exposed any new variables, go ahead and put them into
9318 SSA form now, before we handle jump threading. This simplifies
9319 interactions between rewriting of _DECL nodes into SSA form
9320 and rewriting SSA_NAME nodes into SSA form after block
9321 duplication and CFG manipulation. */
9322 update_ssa (TODO_update_ssa);
9324 finalize_jump_threads ();
9326 /* Remove dead edges from SWITCH_EXPR optimization. This leaves the
9327 CFG in a broken state and requires a cfg_cleanup run. */
9328 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_remove_edges, i, e)
9329 remove_edge (e);
9330 /* Update SWITCH_EXPR case label vector. */
9331 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (to_update_switch_stmts, i, su)
9333 size_t j;
9334 size_t n = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (su->vec);
9335 tree label;
9336 gimple_switch_set_num_labels (su->stmt, n);
9337 for (j = 0; j < n; j++)
9338 gimple_switch_set_label (su->stmt, j, TREE_VEC_ELT (su->vec, j));
9339 /* As we may have replaced the default label with a regular one
9340 make sure to make it a real default label again. This ensures
9341 optimal expansion. */
9342 label = gimple_switch_label (su->stmt, 0);
9343 CASE_LOW (label) = NULL_TREE;
9344 CASE_HIGH (label) = NULL_TREE;
9347 if (to_remove_edges.length () > 0)
9348 free_dominance_info (CDI_DOMINATORS);
9350 to_remove_edges.release ();
9351 to_update_switch_stmts.release ();
9352 threadedge_finalize_values ();
9354 scev_finalize ();
9355 loop_optimizer_finalize ();
9356 return 0;
9359 static bool
9360 gate_vrp (void)
9362 return flag_tree_vrp != 0;
9365 struct gimple_opt_pass pass_vrp =
9368 GIMPLE_PASS,
9369 "vrp", /* name */
9370 OPTGROUP_NONE, /* optinfo_flags */
9371 gate_vrp, /* gate */
9372 execute_vrp, /* execute */
9373 NULL, /* sub */
9374 NULL, /* next */
9375 0, /* static_pass_number */
9376 TV_TREE_VRP, /* tv_id */
9377 PROP_ssa, /* properties_required */
9378 0, /* properties_provided */
9379 0, /* properties_destroyed */
9380 0, /* todo_flags_start */
9381 TODO_cleanup_cfg
9382 | TODO_update_ssa
9383 | TODO_verify_ssa
9384 | TODO_verify_flow
9385 | TODO_ggc_collect /* todo_flags_finish */